blob: b8814277da534c7d8ddef3314a4c217fdb64e67b [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6b07bf72013-12-17 00:45:49 +01007 2013/12/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
727.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
737.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
757.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
767.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078
798. Logging
808.1. Log levels
818.2. Log formats
828.2.1. Default log format
838.2.2. TCP log format
848.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100858.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100868.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200878.3. Advanced logging options
888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
928.4. Timing events
938.5. Session state at disconnection
948.6. Non-printable characters
958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
978.9. Examples of logs
98
999. Statistics and monitoring
1009.1. CSV format
1019.2. Unix Socket commands
102
103
1041. Quick reminder about HTTP
105----------------------------
106
107When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
108fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
109on almost anything found in the contents.
110
111However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
112formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
113correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
114
115
1161.1. The HTTP transaction model
117-------------------------------
118
119The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100120to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
122connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
123will involve a new connection :
124
125 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
126
127In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
128establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
129by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
130length.
131
132Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
133to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
134however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
135response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
136header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
137
138 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
139
140Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
141power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
142but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200143a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144
145A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
146keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
147second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
148page :
149
150 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
151
152This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
153latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
154correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
155the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100156server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100158By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
159connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
160leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
161start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200162
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100163HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
164 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
165 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
166 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
167 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
168 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
169 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
1721.2. HTTP request
173-----------------
174
175First, let's consider this HTTP request :
176
177 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100178 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
180 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
181 3 User-agent: my small browser
182 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
183 5 Accept: image/png
184
185
1861.2.1. The Request line
187-----------------------
188
189Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
190
191 - a METHOD : GET
192 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
193 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
194
195All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
196which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
197followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
198is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
199desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
200the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
201
202The URI itself can have several forms :
203
204 - A "relative URI" :
205
206 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
207
208 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
209 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
210
211 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
212
213 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
214
215 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
216 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
217 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
218 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
219 must accept this form too.
220
221 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
222 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
223 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100224
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
226 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
227 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
228 other protocols too.
229
230In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
231mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
232on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
233It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
234specific to the language, framework or application in use.
235
236
2371.2.2. The request headers
238--------------------------
239
240The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
241beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
242an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
243Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
244values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
245encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
246the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
247define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
248
249Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
250their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
251"Connection:" header).
252
253The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
254that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
255is one valid form of empty line.
256
257Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
258headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
259about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
260application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
261
262Important note:
263 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
264 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
265 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
266 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
267
268
2691.3. HTTP response
270------------------
271
272An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
273messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
274
275 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100276 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200277 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
278 2 Content-length: 350
279 3 Content-Type: text/html
280
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200281As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
282codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
283response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100284continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
285the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
286following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
287sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
288(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
289correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
290such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
291state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
292over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
293if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
294information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296
2971.3.1. The Response line
298------------------------
299
300Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
301
302 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
303 - a status code : 200
304 - a reason : OK
305
306The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200307 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
309 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
310 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
311 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
312
313Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100314"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200315found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
316messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
317or "Authentication Required".
318
319Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
320
321 Code When / reason
322 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
323 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
324 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100326 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
327 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200328 400 for an invalid or too large request
329 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
330 accessing the stats page)
331 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
332 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
333 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
334 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
335 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
336 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
337 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
338 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
339 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
340
341The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3424.2).
343
344
3451.3.2. The response headers
346---------------------------
347
348Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
349the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
350details.
351
352
3532. Configuring HAProxy
354----------------------
355
3562.1. Configuration file format
357------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200358
359HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
360
361 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
362 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
363 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
364 "frontend" and "backend".
365
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100366The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
367referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
368delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100369preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100370escaped by doubling them.
371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372
3732.2. Time format
374----------------
375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100376Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
378otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
379numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
380for every keyword. Supported units are :
381
382 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
383 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
384 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
385 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
386 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
387 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
388
389
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003902.3. Examples
391-------------
392
393 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
394 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
395 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
396 global
397 daemon
398 maxconn 256
399
400 defaults
401 mode http
402 timeout connect 5000ms
403 timeout client 50000ms
404 timeout server 50000ms
405
406 frontend http-in
407 bind *:80
408 default_backend servers
409
410 backend servers
411 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
412
413
414 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
415 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
416 global
417 daemon
418 maxconn 256
419
420 defaults
421 mode http
422 timeout connect 5000ms
423 timeout client 50000ms
424 timeout server 50000ms
425
426 listen http-in
427 bind *:80
428 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
429
430
431Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
432
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100433 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200434
435
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004363. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200437--------------------
438
439Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
440are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
441of them have command-line equivalents.
442
443The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
444
445 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200446 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200448 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200449 - daemon
450 - gid
451 - group
452 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100453 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200454 - nbproc
455 - pidfile
456 - uid
457 - ulimit-n
458 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200459 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100460 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200461 - node
462 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100463 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100464
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200465 * Performance tuning
466 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200467 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100468 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100469 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100470 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200471 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200472 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200473 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200474 - noepoll
475 - nokqueue
476 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100477 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200478 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200479 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200480 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100481 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100482 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200483 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100484 - tune.maxaccept
485 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200486 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200487 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100488 - tune.rcvbuf.client
489 - tune.rcvbuf.server
490 - tune.sndbuf.client
491 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100492 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100493 - tune.ssl.lifetime
494 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100495 - tune.zlib.memlevel
496 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100497
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200498 * Debugging
499 - debug
500 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200501
502
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005033.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504------------------------------------
505
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200506ca-base <dir>
507 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200508 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
509 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200510
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200511chroot <jail dir>
512 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
513 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
514 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
515 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
516 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
517 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100518
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100519cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
520 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
521 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
522 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
523 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
524 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
525 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
526 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
527 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
528 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
529 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
530 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
531 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
532 they overlap.
533
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200534crt-base <dir>
535 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
536 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
537 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
538
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200539daemon
540 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
541 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
542 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
543
544gid <number>
545 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
546 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
547 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100548 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
549 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100551
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552group <group name>
553 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
554 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100555
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200556log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
558 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100559 configured with "log global".
560
561 <address> can be one of:
562
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100563 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100564 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
565 port).
566
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100567 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
568 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
569 port).
570
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100571 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
572 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
573 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
574 writeable).
575
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100576 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
577 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
578 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
579 in Bourne shell.
580
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100581 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582
583 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
584 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
585 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
586
587 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200588 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
589 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
590 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
591 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
592 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
593 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200595 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200596
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100597log-send-hostname [<string>]
598 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
599 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
600 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
601 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
602 the logs.
603
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000604log-tag <string>
605 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
606 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
607 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
608 running on the same host.
609
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610nbproc <number>
611 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
612 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
613 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
614 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
615 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
616
617pidfile <pidfile>
618 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
619 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
620 starting the process. See also "daemon".
621
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100622stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200623 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
624 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
625 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
626 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
627 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
628 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
629 the number of processes used.
630
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100631ssl-server-verify [none|required]
632 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
633 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
634 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
635
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200636stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
637 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
638 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
639 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
640 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200641
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200642 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
643 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
644 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200645
646stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
647 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
648 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100649 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200650
651stats maxconn <connections>
652 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
653 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
654
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200655uid <number>
656 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
657 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
658 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
659 one. See also "gid" and "user".
660
661ulimit-n <number>
662 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
663 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
664 option.
665
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100666unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
667 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
668
669 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
670 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
671 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
672 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
673 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
674 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
675 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
676 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
677 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
678 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
679
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200680user <user name>
681 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
682 See also "uid" and "group".
683
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200684node <name>
685 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
686
687 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
688 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
689 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
690 traffic.
691
692description <text>
693 Add a text that describes the instance.
694
695 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
696 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
697 "<" and ">" characters.
698
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200699
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007003.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200701-----------------------
702
703maxconn <number>
704 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
705 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
706 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
707 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
708
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200709maxconnrate <number>
710 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
711 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
712 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
713 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
714 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
715 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
716 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
717 fairness.
718
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100719maxcomprate <number>
720 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
721 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
722 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
723 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
724 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
725 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
726 default value.
727
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100728maxcompcpuusage <number>
729 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
730 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
731 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
732 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
733 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
734 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
735 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
736 process down and from introducing high latencies.
737
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100738maxpipes <number>
739 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
740 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
741 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
742 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
743 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
744 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
745
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200746maxsessrate <number>
747 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
748 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
749 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
750 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
751 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
752 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
753 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
754 fairness.
755
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200756maxsslconn <number>
757 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
758 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
759 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
760 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
761 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
762 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
763 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
764
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200765maxsslrate <number>
766 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
767 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
768 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
769 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
770 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
771 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
772 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
773 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
774 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
775 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
776
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100777maxzlibmem <number>
778 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
779 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
780 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100781 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
782 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
783 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
784
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200785noepoll
786 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
787 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100788 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200789
790nokqueue
791 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
792 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
793 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
794
795nopoll
796 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
797 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100798 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100799 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200800
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100801nosplice
802 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
803 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
804 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100805 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100806 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
807 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
808 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
809 "option splice-response".
810
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200811spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900812 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
813 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
814 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
815 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
816 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
817 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200818
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200819tune.bufsize <number>
820 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
821 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
822 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
823 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
824 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
825 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
826 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
827 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400828 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
829 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
830 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200831
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200832tune.chksize <number>
833 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
834 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
835 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
836 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
837 checks whenever possible.
838
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100839tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
840 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
841 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
842 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
843 this value. The default value is 1.
844
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100845tune.http.cookielen <number>
846 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
847 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
848 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
849 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
850 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
851 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
852 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
853 to change this value.
854
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200855tune.http.maxhdr <number>
856 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
857 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
858 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
859 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
860 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
861 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
862 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
863 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
864 limit too high.
865
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100866tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100867 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
868 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
869 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
870 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
871 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
872 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
873 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
874 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
875 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
876 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100877
878tune.maxpollevents <number>
879 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
880 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
881 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
882 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
883 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
884
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200885tune.maxrewrite <number>
886 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
887 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
888 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
889 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
890 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
891 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
892 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
893 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
894 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
895 bufsize.
896
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200897tune.pipesize <number>
898 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
899 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
900 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
901 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
902 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
903 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
904
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100905tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
906tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
907 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
908 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
909 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
910 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
911 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
912 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
913 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
914
915tune.sndbuf.client <number>
916tune.sndbuf.server <number>
917 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
918 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
919 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
920 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
921 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
922 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
923 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
924 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
925 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
926 notifying haproxy again.
927
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100928tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100929 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
930 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
931 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
932 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
933 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
934 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
935 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
936 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
937 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100938 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
939 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100940
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100941tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
942 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
943 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
944 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
945 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
946 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
947 being used for too long.
948
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100949tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
950 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
951 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
952 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
953 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
954 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
955 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
956 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
957 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
958 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
959 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
960 best value.
961
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100962tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
963 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
964 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
965 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
966 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
967 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
968
969tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
970 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
971 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
972 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
973 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200974
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009753.3. Debugging
976--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200977
978debug
979 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
980 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
981 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
982 system startup.
983
984quiet
985 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
986 line argument "-q".
987
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200988
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009893.4. Userlists
990--------------
991It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
992http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
993it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
994
995userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100996 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100997 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
998
999group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001000 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001001 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1002 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1003
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001004user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1005 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001006 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1007 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001008 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1009 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001010 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
1011 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
1012
1013
1014 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001015 userlist L1
1016 group G1 users tiger,scott
1017 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001018
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001019 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1020 user scott insecure-password elgato
1021 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001022
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001023 userlist L2
1024 group G1
1025 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001026
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001027 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1028 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1029 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001030
1031 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001033
10343.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001035----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001036It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1037haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1038pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1039identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1040or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1041Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1042known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1043the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1044process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1045during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1046tables.
1047
1048peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001049 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001050 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1051
1052peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1053 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1054 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1055 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1056 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1057 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1058 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1059
1060 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1061 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1062
1063 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1064 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1065 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1066 across all peers.
1067
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001068 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1069 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1070 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1071
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001072 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001073 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001074 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1075 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1076 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001077
1078 backend mybackend
1079 mode tcp
1080 balance roundrobin
1081 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1082 stick on src
1083
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001084 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1085 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001086
1087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010884. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001090
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001091Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1092 - defaults <name>
1093 - frontend <name>
1094 - backend <name>
1095 - listen <name>
1096
1097A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1098its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1099section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001100section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001101
1102A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1103connections.
1104
1105A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1106to forward incoming connections.
1107
1108A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1109parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1110
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001111All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1112'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1113case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1114
1115Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1116logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1117proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1118However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1119name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1120
1121Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1122and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001123bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001124protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1125modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1126arbitrary criteria.
1127
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001128In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1129a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1130the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1131
1132 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1133 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1134 between responses and new requests.
1135
1136 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1137 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1138 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1139 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1140
1141 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1142 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1143 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1144
1145 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1146 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1147 client-facing connection remains open.
1148
1149 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1150 after the end of the response.
1151
1152The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1153frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1154following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1155weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1156
1157 Backend mode
1158
1159 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1160 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1161 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1162 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1163 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1164 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1165 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1166 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1167 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1168 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1169 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1170
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001171
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011734.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1174--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001175
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001176The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1177limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1178they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1179limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001180marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001181option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001182and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1183with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1184specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001185
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001186
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001187 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1188------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1189acl - X X X
1190appsession - - X X
1191backlog X X X -
1192balance X - X X
1193bind - X X -
1194bind-process X X X X
1195block - X X X
1196capture cookie - X X -
1197capture request header - X X -
1198capture response header - X X -
1199clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001200compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001201contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1202cookie X - X X
1203default-server X - X X
1204default_backend X X X -
1205description - X X X
1206disabled X X X X
1207dispatch - - X X
1208enabled X X X X
1209errorfile X X X X
1210errorloc X X X X
1211errorloc302 X X X X
1212-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1213errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001214force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001215fullconn X - X X
1216grace X X X X
1217hash-type X - X X
1218http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001219http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001220http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001221http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001222http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02001223tcp-check expect - - X X
1224tcp-check send - - X X
1225tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001226http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001227id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001228ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001229log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001230maxconn X X X -
1231mode X X X X
1232monitor fail - X X -
1233monitor-net X X X -
1234monitor-uri X X X -
1235option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1236option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1237option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1238option allbackups (*) X - X X
1239option checkcache (*) X - X X
1240option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1241option contstats (*) X X X -
1242option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1243option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1244option forceclose (*) X X X X
1245-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1246option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001247option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001248option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001249option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001250option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001251option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001252option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1253option httpchk X - X X
1254option httpclose (*) X X X X
1255option httplog X X X X
1256option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001257option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001258option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001259option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1260option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1261option logasap (*) X X X -
1262option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001263option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001264option nolinger (*) X X X X
1265option originalto X X X X
1266option persist (*) X - X X
1267option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001268option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001269option smtpchk X - X X
1270option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1271option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1272option splice-request (*) X X X X
1273option splice-response (*) X X X X
1274option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1275option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1276-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001277option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001278option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1279option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1280option tcpka X X X X
1281option tcplog X X X X
1282option transparent (*) X - X X
1283persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1284rate-limit sessions X X X -
1285redirect - X X X
1286redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1287redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1288reqadd - X X X
1289reqallow - X X X
1290reqdel - X X X
1291reqdeny - X X X
1292reqiallow - X X X
1293reqidel - X X X
1294reqideny - X X X
1295reqipass - X X X
1296reqirep - X X X
1297reqisetbe - X X X
1298reqitarpit - X X X
1299reqpass - X X X
1300reqrep - X X X
1301-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1302reqsetbe - X X X
1303reqtarpit - X X X
1304retries X - X X
1305rspadd - X X X
1306rspdel - X X X
1307rspdeny - X X X
1308rspidel - X X X
1309rspideny - X X X
1310rspirep - X X X
1311rsprep - X X X
1312server - - X X
1313source X - X X
1314srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001315stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001316stats auth X - X X
1317stats enable X - X X
1318stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001319stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001320stats realm X - X X
1321stats refresh X - X X
1322stats scope X - X X
1323stats show-desc X - X X
1324stats show-legends X - X X
1325stats show-node X - X X
1326stats uri X - X X
1327-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1328stick match - - X X
1329stick on - - X X
1330stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001331stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001332stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001333tcp-request connection - X X -
1334tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001335tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001336tcp-response content - - X X
1337tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001338timeout check X - X X
1339timeout client X X X -
1340timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1341timeout connect X - X X
1342timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1343timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1344timeout http-request X X X X
1345timeout queue X - X X
1346timeout server X - X X
1347timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1348timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001349timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001350transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001351unique-id-format X X X -
1352unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001353use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001354use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001355------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1356 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1360---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001361
1362This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1363
1364
1365acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1366 Declare or complete an access list.
1367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1368 no | yes | yes | yes
1369 Example:
1370 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1371 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1372 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1373
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001374 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001375
1376
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001377appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1378 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001379 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1381 no | no | yes | yes
1382 Arguments :
1383 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1384 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1385
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001386 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001387 checked in each cookie value.
1388
1389 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1390 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1391 milliseconds.
1392
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001393 request-learn
1394 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1395 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1396 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1397 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1398 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1399 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1400
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001401 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1402 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1403 data following this prefix.
1404
1405 Example :
1406 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1407
1408 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1409 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1410
1411 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1412 2 modes are currently supported :
1413 - path-parameters :
1414 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1415 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1416 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1417 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1418 - query-string :
1419 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1420 query string.
1421
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001422 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1423 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1424 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1425 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001426 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1427 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1428 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001429 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1430 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1431
1432 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1433
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001434 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1435 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1436 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1437
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001438 Example :
1439 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1440
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001441 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1442 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001443
1444
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001445backlog <conns>
1446 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1448 yes | yes | yes | no
1449 Arguments :
1450 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1451 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001452 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001453
1454 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1455 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1456 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1457 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1458 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1459 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1460 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1461 backlog parameter.
1462
1463 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1464 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1465 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1466
1467 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1468
1469
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001470balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001471balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001472 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1474 yes | no | yes | yes
1475 Arguments :
1476 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1477 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1478 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1479 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1480
1481 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1482 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1483 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1484 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001485 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001486 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001487 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1488 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1489 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1490 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1491 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1492 it, so that you don't worry.
1493
1494 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1495 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1496 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1497 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1498 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1499 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1500 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1501 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001502
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001503 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1504 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1505 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1506 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1507 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1508 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1509 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1510 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1511
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001512 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1513 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1514 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1515 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001516 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001517 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1518 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1519 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1520 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1521 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001522 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1523 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1524 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1525 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1526 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1527 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001529 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1530 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1531 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1532 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1533 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1534 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1535 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1536 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001537 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001538 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001539 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1540 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1541 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001542
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001543 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1544 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1545 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1546 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1547 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1548 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1549 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1550 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1551 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1552 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1553 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1554 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001555
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001556 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001557 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1558 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1559 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1560 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1561 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1562 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1563 URIs start with a leading "/".
1564
1565 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1566 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1567 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1568 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1569
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001571 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1572
1573 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001574 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1575 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1576 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1577 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1578 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1579 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1580 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1581 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1582 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1583 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1584 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1585 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1586 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1587 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1588 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1589 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1590 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1591 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1592 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001593
1594 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1595 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1596 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1597 server will receive the request.
1598
1599 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1600 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1601 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1602 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1603 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001604 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1605 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1606 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001607
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001608 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1609 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1610 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1611 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1612 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001613
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001614 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001615 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1616 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1617 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1618
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001619 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1620 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1621 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1622
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001623 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001624 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001625 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1626 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1627 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1628 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1629 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1630 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001631 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001632 used instead.
1633
1634 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1635 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1636 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1637 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1638
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001639 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1640 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1641 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1642
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001643 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001644
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001645 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001646 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1647 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001648
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001649 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001650 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001651
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001652 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1653 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1654 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001655
1656 Examples :
1657 balance roundrobin
1658 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001659 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001660 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1661 balance hdr(host)
1662 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001663
1664 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1665 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1666
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001667 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001668 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1669 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1670 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1671 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1672
1673 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1674 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1675 defaults to 16 kB.
1676
1677 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1678 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1679
1680 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1681 Round Robin.
1682
1683 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1684 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1685 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1686 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1687
1688 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1689
1690 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001691 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001692 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1693 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1694 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001695
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001696 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1697 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001698
1699
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001700bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1701bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001702 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1704 no | yes | yes | no
1705 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001706 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1707 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1708 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1709 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001710 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001711 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1712 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1713 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1714 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1715 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1716 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1717 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001718 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1719 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1720 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001721 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1722 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1723 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1724 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001725
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001726 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1727 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001728 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1729 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1730 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001731 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1732 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1733 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1734 the range.
1735
1736 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1737 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1738 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1739 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1740 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1741 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1742 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001743 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001744 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001745
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001746 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1747 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1748 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1749 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1750 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1751 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1752 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1753 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1754
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001755 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1756 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1757 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1758 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001759
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001760 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1761 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1762 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1763 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1764 in a frontend.
1765
1766 Example :
1767 listen http_proxy
1768 bind :80,:443
1769 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001770 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001771
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001772 listen http_https_proxy
1773 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001774 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001775
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001776 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1777 bind ipv6@:80
1778 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1779 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1780
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001781 listen external_bind_app1
1782 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1783
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001784 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001785 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786
1787
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001788bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001789 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1791 yes | yes | yes | yes
1792 Arguments :
1793 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1794 may be used to override a default value.
1795
1796 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1797 option may be combined with other numbers.
1798
1799 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1800 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1801 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1802 missing from all processes.
1803
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001804 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1805 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1806 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1807 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1808 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001809
1810 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1811 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1812 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1813 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1814 and 'even' instances.
1815
1816 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1817 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1818 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1819 32.
1820
1821 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1822 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1823
1824 Example :
1825 listen app_ip1
1826 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001827 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001828
1829 listen app_ip2
1830 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001831 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001832
1833 listen management
1834 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001835 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001836
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001837 listen management
1838 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1839 bind-process 1-4
1840
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001841 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1842
1843
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001844block { if | unless } <condition>
1845 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1847 no | yes | yes | yes
1848
1849 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1850 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001851 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001852 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001853 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1854 "block" statements per instance.
1855
1856 Example:
1857 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1858 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1859 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1860 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001862 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001863
1864
1865capture cookie <name> len <length>
1866 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1868 no | yes | yes | no
1869 Arguments :
1870 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1871 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1872 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1873 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1874 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1875
1876 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1877 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1878 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1879 right if it exceeds <length>.
1880
1881 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1882 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1883 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1884 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1885
1886 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1887 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1888 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1889
1890 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1891 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1892 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001893 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1894 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1895 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001896
1897 Example:
1898 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1899
1900 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001901 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001902
1903
1904capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001905 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1907 no | yes | yes | no
1908 Arguments :
1909 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001910 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001911 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1912 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1913 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1914
1915 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1916 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1917 it exceeds <length>.
1918
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001919 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001920 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1921 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001922 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1923 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1924 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1925 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001926 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001927 environments to find where the request came from.
1928
1929 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1930 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1931 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1932 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001933
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001934 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1935 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1936 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1937 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1938 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001939
1940 Example:
1941 capture request header Host len 15
1942 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1943 capture request header Referrer len 15
1944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001945 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001946 about logging.
1947
1948
1949capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001950 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1952 no | yes | yes | no
1953 Arguments :
1954 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001955 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1957 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1958 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1959
1960 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1961 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1962 it exceeds <length>.
1963
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001964 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001965 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1966 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1967 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001968 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1969 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1970 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1971 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001972
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001973 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1974 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1975 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1976 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1977 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001978
1979 Example:
1980 capture response header Content-length len 9
1981 capture response header Location len 15
1982
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001983 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001984 about logging.
1985
1986
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001987clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001988 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1990 yes | yes | yes | no
1991 Arguments :
1992 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1993 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1994 as explained at the top of this document.
1995
1996 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1997 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1998 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1999 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2000 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2001 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2002 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2003 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002004 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002005 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2006 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2007
2008 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2009 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2010 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2011 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2012 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2013 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2014
2015 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2016 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2017
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002018 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2019 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002021compression algo <algorithm> ...
2022compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002023compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002024 Enable HTTP compression.
2025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2026 yes | yes | yes | yes
2027 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002028 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2029 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2030 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2031
2032 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002033 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002034 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2035 data.
2036
2037 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2038 support for zlib was built in.
2039
2040 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2041 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2042 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2043 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2044 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2045 in.
2046
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002047 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002048 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002049 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2050 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2051 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2052 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2053 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002054
2055 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2056 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2057 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2058 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2059 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002060 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2061 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2062 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2063 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2064 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2065 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002066
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002067 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002068 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2069 "Accept-Encoding" header
2070 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002071 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002072 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2073 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002074 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2075 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2076 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2077 "multipart"
2078 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2079 header
2080 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2081 and later
2082 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2083 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002084
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002085 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2086 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002087
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002088 Examples :
2089 compression algo gzip
2090 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002091
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002092contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002093 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2095 yes | no | yes | yes
2096 Arguments :
2097 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2098 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2099 as explained at the top of this document.
2100
2101 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002102 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002103 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002104 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2105 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2106 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2107 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2108
2109 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2110 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2111 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2112 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2113 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2114 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2115
2116 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2117 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2118 instead.
2119
2120 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2121 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2122
2123
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002124cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002125 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2126 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002127 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2129 yes | no | yes | yes
2130 Arguments :
2131 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2132 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2133 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2134 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2135 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2136 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2137 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2138 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2139 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2140
2141 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2142 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2143 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2144 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2145 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2146 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2147 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2148 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2149 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2150 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2151 "insert" and "prefix".
2152
2153 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002154 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002155
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002156 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002157 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2158 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2159 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2160 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2161 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2162 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2163 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2164 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2165 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2166 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002167
2168 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2169 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2170 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2171 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2172 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2173 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2174 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2175 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2176 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2177 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002178 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2179 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2180 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002181
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002182 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2183 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2184 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002185 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2186 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2187 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2188 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002189 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2190 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2191 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002192
2193 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2194 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2195 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2196 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2197 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2198 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2199 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2200 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2201 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2202
2203 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2204 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2205 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2206 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2207 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2208 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2209 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2210 persistence cookie in the cache.
2211 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2212
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002213 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2214 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2215 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2216 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2217 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2218 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2219 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2220 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2221 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2222 they logout.
2223
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002224 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2225 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2226 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2227 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2228
2229 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2230 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2231 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2232 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2233 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2234 this attribute.
2235
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002236 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002237 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002238 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2239 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2240 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2241 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2242 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2243 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002244
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002245 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2246 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2247 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2248 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2249 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2250 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2251 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2252 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2253 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2254 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2255 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2256 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2257 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2258 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2259 the site.
2260
2261 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2262 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2263 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2264 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2265 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2266 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2267 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2268 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2269 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2270 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2271 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2272 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2273 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2274 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2275 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2276 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2277
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002278 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2279 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2280 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2281 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002282
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002283 Examples :
2284 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2285 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2286 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002287 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002288
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002289 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002290 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002291
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002292
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002293default-server [param*]
2294 Change default options for a server in a backend
2295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2296 yes | no | yes | yes
2297 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002298 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2299 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2300 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2301 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002302
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002303 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002304 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2305
2306 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002308
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002309default_backend <backend>
2310 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2312 yes | yes | yes | no
2313 Arguments :
2314 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2315
2316 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2317 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2318 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2319 will catch all undetermined requests.
2320
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002321 Example :
2322
2323 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2324 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2325 default_backend dynamic
2326
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002327 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2328
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002329
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002330description <string>
2331 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2333 no | yes | yes | yes
2334 Arguments : string
2335
2336 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2337 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2338 it describes.
2339 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2340
2341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342disabled
2343 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2345 yes | yes | yes | yes
2346 Arguments : none
2347
2348 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2349 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2350 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2351 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2352 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2353 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2354 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2355
2356 See also : "enabled"
2357
2358
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002359dispatch <address>:<port>
2360 Set a default server address
2361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2362 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002363 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002364
2365 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2366 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2367 during start-up.
2368
2369 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2370 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2371 possible with normal servers.
2372
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002373 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002374 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2375 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2376 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2377 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2378
2379 See also : "server"
2380
2381
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002382enabled
2383 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2385 yes | yes | yes | yes
2386 Arguments : none
2387
2388 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2389 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2390
2391 See also : "disabled"
2392
2393
2394errorfile <code> <file>
2395 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2397 yes | yes | yes | yes
2398 Arguments :
2399 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002400 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002401
2402 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002403 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002404 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002405 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2406 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002407
2408 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2409 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2410 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2411
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002412 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2413
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002414 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2415 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2416 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2417 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2418
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002419 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2420 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2421 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2422 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2423 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2424 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2425
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002426 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2427 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2428 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002429 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002430 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2431
2432 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2433
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002434 Example :
2435 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2436 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2437 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2438
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002439
2440errorloc <code> <url>
2441errorloc302 <code> <url>
2442 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2444 yes | yes | yes | yes
2445 Arguments :
2446 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002447 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002448
2449 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2450 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2451 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2452 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2453 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2454
2455 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2456 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2457 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2458
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002459 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2460
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002461 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2462 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2463 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2464 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2465 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2466 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2467 request.
2468
2469 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2470
2471
2472errorloc303 <code> <url>
2473 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2475 yes | yes | yes | yes
2476 Arguments :
2477 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2478 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2479
2480 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2481 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2482 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2483 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2484 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2485
2486 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2487 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2488 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2489
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002490 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2491
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002492 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2493 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2494 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2495 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002496 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002497
2498 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2499
2500
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002501force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2502 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2503 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2504 no | yes | yes | yes
2505
2506 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2507 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2508 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2509 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2510 marked down for maintenance operations.
2511
2512 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2513 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2514 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2515 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2516 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2517 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2518 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2519 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2520 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2521
2522 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2523 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2524 is used.
2525
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002526 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002527 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002528
2529
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002530fullconn <conns>
2531 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2533 yes | no | yes | yes
2534 Arguments :
2535 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2536 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2537
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002538 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002539 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002540 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002541 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2542 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2543 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2544 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2545 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002546 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002547
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002548 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2549 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2550 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2551
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002552 Example :
2553 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2554 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2555 # connections.
2556 backend dynamic
2557 fullconn 10000
2558 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2559 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2560
2561 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2562
2563
2564grace <time>
2565 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002567 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002568 Arguments :
2569 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2570 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2571 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2572
2573 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2574 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002575 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002576 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2577
2578 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2579 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2580 simplify it.
2581
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002582
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002583hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002584 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2586 yes | no | yes | yes
2587 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002588 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2589 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002590
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002591 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2592 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2593 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2594 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2595 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2596 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2597 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2598 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2599 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2600 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002601
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002602 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2603 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2604 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2605 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2606 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2607 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2608 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2609 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2610 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2611 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2612 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2613 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2614 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002615 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2616 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002617
2618 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2619
2620 sdbm this function was created intially for sdbm (a public-domain
2621 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2622 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2623 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002624 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2625 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2626 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002627
2628 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2629 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002630 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2631 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2632 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2633 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2634
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002635 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2636 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2637 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2638 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2639 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2640 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2641 parameter.
2642
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002643 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2644
2645 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2646 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2647 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2648 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2649 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2650 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2651 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2652 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2653 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2654 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2655 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2656 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002657
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002658 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2659 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2660 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002661
2662 See also : "balance", "server"
2663
2664
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002665http-check disable-on-404
2666 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002668 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002669 Arguments : none
2670
2671 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2672 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2673 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2674 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2675 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2676 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2677 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2678 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002679 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2680 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2681 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2682
2683 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2684
2685
2686http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002687 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002689 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002690 Arguments :
2691 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2692 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002693 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002694 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2695 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2696 details on the supported keywords.
2697
2698 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2699 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2700 with the usual backslash ('\').
2701
2702 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2703 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2704 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2705 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2706 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2707
2708 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002709 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002710 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2711 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2712 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2713
2714 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002715 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002716 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2717 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2718 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2719 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2720
2721 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002722 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002723 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2724 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2725 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2726 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2727 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2728 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2729 trace).
2730
2731 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002732 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002733 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2734 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2735 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2736 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2737 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2738 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2739
2740 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2741 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2742 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2743 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2744 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2745 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2746 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2747 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2748
2749 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2750 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2751
2752 Examples :
2753 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002754 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002755
2756 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002757 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002758
2759 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002760 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002761
2762 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002763 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002764
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002765 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002766
2767
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002768http-check send-state
2769 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2771 yes | no | yes | yes
2772 Arguments : none
2773
2774 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2775 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2776 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2777 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2778 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2779
2780 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2781 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2782 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2783 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2784 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2785 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2786 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2787 checked in multiple backends.
2788
2789 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2790 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2791
2792 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2793 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2794 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2795 one fails.
2796
2797 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2798 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2799 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2800
2801 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2802 server's queue.
2803
2804 Example of a header received by the application server :
2805 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2806 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2807
2808 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2809
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002810http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002811 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002812 set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> | set-tos <tos> |
2813 set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002814 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002815 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2816
2817 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2818 no | yes | yes | yes
2819
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002820 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2821 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2822 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2823 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2824 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002825
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002826 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2827 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2828 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2829
2830 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2831 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2832 are evaluated.
2833
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002834 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2835 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2836 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2837 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2838 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2839 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2840 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2841 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2842 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2843 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2844 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2845
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002846 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2847 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2848 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2849 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2850 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2851
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002852 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2853 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2854 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002855 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2856 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002857
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002858 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2859 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2860 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2861 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2862 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2863 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2864 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2865 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2866
2867 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2868 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2869 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2870 external users.
2871
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002872 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2873 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2874 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2875 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2876 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2877 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2878 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2879 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2880
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002881 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2882 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2883 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2884 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2885 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2886 another equipment.
2887
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002888 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2889 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2890 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2891 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2892 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2893 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2894 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2895 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2896
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002897 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2898 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2899 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2900 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2901 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2902 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2903 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2904 admin privileges.
2905
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002906 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2907
2908 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2909 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2910 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2911 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002912
2913 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002914 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2915 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2916 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002917
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002918 http-request allow if nagios
2919 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2920 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2921 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002922
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002923 Example:
2924 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002925 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002926
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002927 Example:
2928 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2929 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2930 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2931 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2932 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2933 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2934 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2935 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2936 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2937
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002938 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2939 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002940
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002941http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002942 set-header <name> <fmt> | set-log-level <level> |
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002943 set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
2944 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002945 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2946
2947 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2948 no | yes | yes | yes
2949
2950 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2951 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2952 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2953 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2954 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2955 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2956
2957 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2958 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2959 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
2960 current section.
2961
2962 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2963 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
2964 rules are evaluated.
2965
2966 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2967 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2968 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
2969 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
2970 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
2971 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
2972 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
2973
2974 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2975 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2976 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2977 external users.
2978
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002979 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2980 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2981 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2982 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2983 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2984 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2985 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2986 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2987
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002988 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2989 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2990 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2991 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2992 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2993 another equipment.
2994
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002995 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2996 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2997 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2998 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2999 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3000 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3001 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3002 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3003
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003004 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3005 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3006 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3007 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3008 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3009 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3010 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3011 admin privileges.
3012
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003013 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3014
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003015 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003016 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3017 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3018 rules.
3019
3020 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3021 ACL usage.
3022
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003023
3024tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
3025 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
3026 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3027 no | no | yes | yes
3028
3029 Arguments :
3030 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3031 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
3032 binary.
3033 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
3034 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
3035 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
3036
3037 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3038 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3039 with the usual backslash ('\').
3040 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
3041 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
3042 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
3043 used upper or lower case.
3044
3045
3046 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
3047
3048 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
3049 A health check response will be considered valid if the
3050 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
3051 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3052 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3053 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
3054 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
3055 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
3056
3057 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
3058 A health check response will be considered valid if the
3059 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
3060 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3061 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
3062 expression.
3063
3064 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
3065 in the response buffer. A health check response will
3066 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
3067 this exact hexadecimal string.
3068 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
3069
3070 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3071 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3072 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3073 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
3074 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3075 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3076 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3077 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
3078 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
3079 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
3080 the null character.
3081
3082 Examples :
3083 # perform a POP check
3084 option tcp-check
3085 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3086
3087 # perform an IMAP check
3088 option tcp-check
3089 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3090
3091 # look for the redis master server
3092 option tcp-check
3093 tcp-check send PING\r\n
3094 tcp-check expect +PONG
3095 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3096 tcp-check expect string role:master
3097 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
3098 tcp-check expect string +OK
3099
3100
3101 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "http-check expect",
3102 tune.chksize
3103
3104
3105tcp-check send <data>
3106 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3107 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3108 no | no | yes | yes
3109
3110 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3111 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3112
3113 Examples :
3114 # look for the redis master server
3115 option tcp-check
3116 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3117 tcp-check expect string role:master
3118
3119 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send-binary",
3120 tune.chksize
3121
3122
3123tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
3124 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
3125 tcp health check
3126 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3127 no | no | yes | yes
3128
3129 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3130 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3131 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
3132 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
3133 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
3134 hexadecimal string.
3135 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
3136
3137 Examples :
3138 # redis check in binary
3139 option tcp-check
3140 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
3141 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
3142
3143
3144 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send",
3145 tune.chksize
3146
3147
3148
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003149http-send-name-header [<header>]
3150 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3151
3152 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3153 yes | no | yes | yes
3154
3155 Arguments :
3156
3157 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3158
3159 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3160 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3161 is added with the header string proved.
3162
3163 See also : "server"
3164
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003165id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003166 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3168 no | yes | yes | yes
3169 Arguments : none
3170
3171 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3172 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3173 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003174
3175
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003176ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3177 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3178 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3179 no | yes | yes | yes
3180
3181 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3182 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3183 and running).
3184
3185 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3186 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3187 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
3188 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
3189 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3190
3191 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3192 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3193
3194 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3195 "unless" condition is met.
3196
3197 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3198
3199
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003200log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003201log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003202no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003203 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3205 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003206
3207 Prefix :
3208 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3209 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3210 prefix does not allow arguments.
3211
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003212 Arguments :
3213 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3214 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3215 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3216 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3217 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3218 parameter.
3219
3220 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3221 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3222
3223 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3224 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3225 standard syslog port).
3226
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003227 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3228 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3229 standard syslog port).
3230
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003231 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3232 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3233 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3234 appropriately writeable).
3235
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003236 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3237 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3238 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3239 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3240
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003241 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3242
3243 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3244 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3245 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3246
3247 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3248 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3249 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003250 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3251 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3252 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3253 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3254 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003255
3256 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3257
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003258 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3259 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3260 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003261
3262 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3263 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3264 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3265 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3266
3267 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3268 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003269
3270 Example :
3271 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003272 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3273 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003274 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3275
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003276
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003277log-format <string>
3278 Allows you to custom a log line.
3279
3280 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3281
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003282
3283maxconn <conns>
3284 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3286 yes | yes | yes | no
3287 Arguments :
3288 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3289 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3290 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3291 closes.
3292
3293 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3294 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3295 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3296 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3297 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3298 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3299 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3300 properly tuned.
3301
3302 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3303 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3304 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3305
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003306 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3307
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003308 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3309
3310
3311mode { tcp|http|health }
3312 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3314 yes | yes | yes | yes
3315 Arguments :
3316 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3317 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3318 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3319 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3320
3321 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3322 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3323 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3324 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3325 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3326
3327 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003328 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3329 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3330 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3331 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3332 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3333 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3334 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003335
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003336 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3337 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3338 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003339
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003340 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003341 defaults http_instances
3342 mode http
3343
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003344 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003345
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003346
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003347monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003348 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3350 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003351 Arguments :
3352 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3353 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003354 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003355 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3356 backend and its backup.
3357
3358 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3359 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3360 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3361 servers in a list of backends.
3362
3363 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3364 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3365 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3366 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3367 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3368 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3369 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003370 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3371 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003372
3373 Example:
3374 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003375 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003376 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3377 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3378 monitor-uri /site_alive
3379 monitor fail if site_dead
3380
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003381 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003382
3383
3384monitor-net <source>
3385 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3387 yes | yes | yes | no
3388 Arguments :
3389 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3390 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3391 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3392 followed by a mask.
3393
3394 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3395 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003396 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003397 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3398
3399 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3400 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3401 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3402 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003403 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3404 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3405 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003406
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003407 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3408 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3409 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3410 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3411 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3412 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003413
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003414 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3415 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003416
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003417 Example :
3418 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3419 frontend www
3420 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3421
3422 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3423
3424
3425monitor-uri <uri>
3426 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3428 yes | yes | yes | no
3429 Arguments :
3430 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3431 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3432
3433 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3434 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3435 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3436 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3437 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3438 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3439 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3440 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3441
3442 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3443 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3444 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3445 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3446 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3447 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3448
3449 Example :
3450 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3451 frontend www
3452 mode http
3453 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3454
3455 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3456
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003457
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003458option abortonclose
3459no option abortonclose
3460 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3462 yes | no | yes | yes
3463 Arguments : none
3464
3465 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3466 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3467 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3468 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003469 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003470 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3471 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3472 encountered while delivering the response.
3473
3474 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3475 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3476 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3477 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3478 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3479 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003480 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003481 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003482 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003483 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3484 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3485 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3486
3487 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3488 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3489 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3490 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3491 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3492 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3493 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3494 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003495 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003496
3497 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3498 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3499
3500 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3501
3502
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003503option accept-invalid-http-request
3504no option accept-invalid-http-request
3505 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3507 yes | yes | yes | no
3508 Arguments : none
3509
3510 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3511 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3512 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3513 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3514 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3515 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3516 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3517 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003518 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3519 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3520 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3521 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3522 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3523 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003524
3525 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3526 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3527 been confirmed.
3528
3529 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3530 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003531 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3532 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003533 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3534
3535 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3536 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3537
3538 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3539 stats socket.
3540
3541
3542option accept-invalid-http-response
3543no option accept-invalid-http-response
3544 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3546 yes | no | yes | yes
3547 Arguments : none
3548
3549 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3550 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3551 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3552 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3553 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3554 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3555 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3556 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3557 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3558
3559 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3560 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3561 been confirmed.
3562
3563 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3564 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3565 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3566 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3567
3568 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3569 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3570
3571 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3572 stats socket.
3573
3574
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003575option allbackups
3576no option allbackups
3577 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3579 yes | no | yes | yes
3580 Arguments : none
3581
3582 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3583 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3584 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3585 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3586 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3587 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3588 order between the backup servers anymore.
3589
3590 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3591 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3592
3593 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3594 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3595
3596
3597option checkcache
3598no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003599 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3601 yes | no | yes | yes
3602 Arguments : none
3603
3604 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3605 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003606 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003607 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3608 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003609 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003610
3611 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003612 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003613 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003614 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3615 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003616 to the client are :
3617 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003618 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003619 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003620 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3621 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3622 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3623 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3624 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3625 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3626 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3627 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3628 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3629 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3630 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3631
3632 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003633 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003634 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003635 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003636 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3637
3638 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3639 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003640 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003641 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3642
3643 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3644 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3645
3646
3647option clitcpka
3648no option clitcpka
3649 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3651 yes | yes | yes | no
3652 Arguments : none
3653
3654 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3655 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3656 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3657 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3658
3659 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3660 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3661 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3662 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3663
3664 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3665 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3666 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3667 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3668 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3669
3670 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3671
3672 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3673 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3674 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3675
3676 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3677 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3678
3679 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3680
3681
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003682option contstats
3683 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3685 yes | yes | yes | no
3686 Arguments : none
3687
3688 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3689 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3690 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3691 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3692 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3693 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3694 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3695
3696
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003697option dontlog-normal
3698no option dontlog-normal
3699 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3701 yes | yes | yes | no
3702 Arguments : none
3703
3704 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3705 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3706 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3707 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3708 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3709 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3710 logged.
3711
3712 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3713 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3714 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3715
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003716 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003717 logging.
3718
3719
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003720option dontlognull
3721no option dontlognull
3722 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3724 yes | yes | yes | no
3725 Arguments : none
3726
3727 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3728 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3729 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3730 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3731 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3732 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3733 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3734
3735 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3736 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3737 would not be logged.
3738
3739 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3740 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3741
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003742 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003743
3744
3745option forceclose
3746no option forceclose
3747 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003749 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003750 Arguments : none
3751
3752 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3753 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3754 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3755 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3756 global session times in the logs.
3757
3758 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003759 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003760 to respond and release some resources earlier than with 'option httpclose'.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003761
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003762 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3763 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3764 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3765
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003766 This option disables and replaces any previous 'option httpclose', 'option
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003767 http-server-close', 'option http-keep-alive', or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003768
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003769 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3770 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3771
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003772 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003773
3774
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003775option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003776 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3778 yes | yes | yes | yes
3779 Arguments :
3780 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3781 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003782 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003783 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003784
3785 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3786 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3787 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3788 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3789 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3790 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3791 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003792 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3793 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3794 possible that the client has already brought one.
3795
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003796 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003797 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003798 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3799 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003800 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3801 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003802
3803 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3804 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3805 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3806 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3807 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3808 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3809 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3810
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003811 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3812 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3813 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3814 are under the control of the end-user.
3815
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003816 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003817 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3818 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003819 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3820 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3821 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003822
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003823 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003824 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3825 frontend www
3826 mode http
3827 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3828
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003829 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3830 backend www
3831 mode http
3832 option forwardfor header X-Client
3833
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003834 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003835 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003836
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003837
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003838option http-keep-alive
3839no option http-keep-alive
3840 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3842 yes | yes | yes | yes
3843 Arguments : none
3844
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003845 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3846 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3847 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
3848 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
3849 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3850 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
3851 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
3852
3853 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
3854 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003855 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3856 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3857 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3858 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3859 situations where this option may be useful :
3860
3861 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3862 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3863
3864 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3865 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3866
3867 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3868 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3869 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3870 request.
3871
3872 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3873 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003874 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3875 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3876 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003877
3878 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3879 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3880
3881 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3882 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3883 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3884 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3885 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3886 not set.
3887
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003888 This option disables and replaces any previous 'option httpclose', 'option
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003889 http-server-close', 'option forceclose' or "option http-tunnel". When backend
3890 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
3891 'option http-keep-alive'.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003892
3893 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003894 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3895 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003896
3897
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003898option http-no-delay
3899no option http-no-delay
3900 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3902 yes | yes | yes | yes
3903 Arguments : none
3904
3905 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3906 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3907 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3908 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3909 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3910 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3911 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3912 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3913 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3914 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3915 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3916 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3917 affected.
3918
3919 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3920 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3921 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3922 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3923 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3924 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3925 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3926 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3927 latency environments.
3928
3929
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003930option http-pretend-keepalive
3931no option http-pretend-keepalive
3932 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3934 yes | yes | yes | yes
3935 Arguments : none
3936
3937 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3938 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3939 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3940 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3941 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3942 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3943 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3944 consider the response complete.
3945
3946 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3947 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3948 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3949 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3950 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3951 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3952
3953 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3954 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3955 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3956 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3957 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3958 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3959 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3960
3961 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3962 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003963 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003964 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3965 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003966
3967 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3968 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3969
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003970 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
3971 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003972
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003973
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003974option http-server-close
3975no option http-server-close
3976 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3978 yes | yes | yes | yes
3979 Arguments : none
3980
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003981 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3982 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3983 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
3984 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
3985 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3986 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
3987 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
3988 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
3989 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
3990 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
3991 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
3992 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
3993 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
3994 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
3995 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
3996 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003997
3998 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3999 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4000 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4001 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004002 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4003 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004004
4005 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4006 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004007 It disables and replaces any previous 'option httpclose', 'option forceclose',
4008 'option http-tunnel' or 'option http-keep-alive'. Please check section 4
4009 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4010 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004011
4012 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4013 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4014
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004015 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004016 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4017 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004018
4019
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004020option http-tunnel
4021no option http-tunnel
4022 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4024 yes | yes | yes | yes
4025 Arguments : none
4026
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004027 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4028 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4029 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4030 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4031 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4032 "option http-tunnel".
4033
4034 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
4035 the first respones. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
4036 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4037 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4038 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4039 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4040 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4041 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4042 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004043
4044 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4045 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4046
4047 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4048 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4049 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4050
4051
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004052option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004053no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004054 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4056 yes | yes | yes | no
4057 Arguments : none
4058
4059 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4060 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4061 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4062 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4063 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4064 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4065 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4066
4067 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4068 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4069 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4070 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4071 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4072 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4073 request along its whole life.
4074
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004075 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4076 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4077 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4078 front of an existing proxy.
4079
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004080 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4081
4082 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4083 http-server-close".
4084
4085
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004086option httpchk
4087option httpchk <uri>
4088option httpchk <method> <uri>
4089option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4090 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4092 yes | no | yes | yes
4093 Arguments :
4094 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4095 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4096 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4097 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4098 ones.
4099
4100 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4101 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4102 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4103
4104 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4105 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4106 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4107 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4108 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4109
4110 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4111 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4112 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4113 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4114 the lack of any response.
4115
4116 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4117
4118 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4119 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4120 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4121
4122 Examples :
4123 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4124 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4125 backend https_relay
4126 mode tcp
4127 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4128 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4129
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004130 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4131 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4132 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004133
4134
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004135option httpclose
4136no option httpclose
4137 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4139 yes | yes | yes | yes
4140 Arguments : none
4141
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004142 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4143 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4144 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4145 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4146 as "option http-serve-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4147 "option http-tunnel".
4148
4149 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4150 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4151 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4152 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4153 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4154 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4155 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4156 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004157
4158 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004159 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004160 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4161 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4162 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4163 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4164 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004165
4166 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4167 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004168 It disables and replaces any previous 'option http-server-close',
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004169 'option forceclose', 'option http-keep-alive' or "option http-tunnel". Please
4170 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4171 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004172
4173 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4174 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4175
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004176 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4177 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004178
4179
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004180option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004181 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4183 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004184 Arguments :
4185 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4186 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4187 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4188 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4189 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004190
4191 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4192 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4193 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4194 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4195 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4196 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4197 ports.
4198
4199 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4200
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004201 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4202 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4203 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4204 by default.
4205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004206 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004207
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004208
4209option http_proxy
4210no option http_proxy
4211 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4213 yes | yes | yes | yes
4214 Arguments : none
4215
4216 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4217 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4218 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4219 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4220 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4221
4222 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4223 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4224 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4225 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004226 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004227 be analyzed.
4228
4229 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4230 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4231
4232 Example :
4233 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4234 backend direct_forward
4235 option httpclose
4236 option http_proxy
4237
4238 See also : "option httpclose"
4239
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004240
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004241option independent-streams
4242no option independent-streams
4243 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4245 yes | yes | yes | yes
4246 Arguments : none
4247
4248 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4249 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4250 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4251 receive data or not.
4252
4253 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4254 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4255 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4256 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4257 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4258 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4259 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4260 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4261 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4262 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4263 socket buffers.
4264
4265 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4266 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4267 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4268 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4269 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4270
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004271 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
4272 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4273 deprecated.
4274
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004275 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004276
4277
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004278option ldap-check
4279 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4281 yes | no | yes | yes
4282 Arguments : none
4283
4284 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4285 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4286 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4287 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4288
4289 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4290 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4291
4292 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4293 configure it.
4294
4295 Example :
4296 option ldap-check
4297
4298 See also : "option httpchk"
4299
4300
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004301option log-health-checks
4302no option log-health-checks
4303 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4305 yes | no | yes | yes
4306 Arguments : none
4307
4308 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4309 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4310 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4311 of additional information is limited.
4312
4313 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4314 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4315
4316 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4317
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004318
4319option log-separate-errors
4320no option log-separate-errors
4321 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4323 yes | yes | yes | no
4324 Arguments : none
4325
4326 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4327 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4328 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4329 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4330 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4331 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4332 provides very important information.
4333
4334 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4335 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4336 error logs.
4337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004338 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004339 logging.
4340
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004341
4342option logasap
4343no option logasap
4344 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4346 yes | yes | yes | no
4347 Arguments : none
4348
4349 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4350 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4351 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4352 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4353 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4354 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4355 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004356 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004357 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4358 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4359
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004360 Examples :
4361 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4362 mode http
4363 option httplog
4364 option logasap
4365 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4366
4367 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4368 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4369 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4370 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004372 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004373 logging.
4374
4375
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004376option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4377 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4379 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004380 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004381 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4382 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004383
4384 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4385 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4386 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4387 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4388 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4389 in the MySQL table, like this :
4390
4391 USE mysql;
4392 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4393 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4394
4395 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4396 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4397 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4398 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4399 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4400 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4401 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4402 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4403 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4404
4405 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4406 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004407
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004408 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004409
4410 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4411 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4412 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4413 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4414 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4415 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4416
4417 See also: "option httpchk"
4418
4419
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004420option nolinger
4421no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004422 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004423 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4424 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004425 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004426
4427 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4428 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4429 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4430 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4431 connections.
4432
4433 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4434 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4435 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4436 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4437 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4438 this too.
4439
4440 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4441 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4442 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4443
4444 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4445 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4446 for servers.
4447
4448 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4449 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4450
4451
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004452option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4453 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4455 yes | yes | yes | yes
4456 Arguments :
4457 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4458 matching <network>
4459 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4460 header name.
4461
4462 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4463 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4464 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4465 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4466 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4467 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4468 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4469 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4470 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4471 possible that the client has already brought one.
4472
4473 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4474 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4475 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4476 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4477 header and requires different one.
4478
4479 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4480 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4481 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4482 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4483 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4484 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4485 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4486
4487 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4488 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4489 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4490 both are defined.
4491
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004492 Examples :
4493 # Original Destination address
4494 frontend www
4495 mode http
4496 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4497
4498 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4499 backend www
4500 mode http
4501 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4502
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004503 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4504 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004505
4506
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004507option persist
4508no option persist
4509 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4510 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4511 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004512 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004513
4514 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4515 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4516 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4517 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4518 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4519 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4520 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4521 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4522 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4523 redirected to another valid server.
4524
4525 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4526 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4527
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004528 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004529
4530
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004531option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4532 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4534 yes | no | yes | yes
4535 Arguments :
4536 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4537 PostgreSQL server.
4538
4539 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4540 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4541 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4542 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4543
4544 See also: "option httpchk"
4545
4546
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004547option prefer-last-server
4548no option prefer-last-server
4549 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4550 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4551 yes | no | yes | yes
4552 Arguments : none
4553
4554 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4555 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4556 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4557 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4558 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4559 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4560 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4561 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4562 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004563 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4564 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4565 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4566 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4567 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4568 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4569 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004570
4571 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4572 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4573
4574 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4575
4576
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004577option redispatch
4578no option redispatch
4579 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4580 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4581 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004582 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004583
4584 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4585 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4586 be able to access the service anymore.
4587
4588 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4589 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4590
4591 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4592 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4593 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004594
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004595 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4596 "redisp" keywords.
4597
4598 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4599 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4600
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004601 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004602
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004603
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004604option redis-check
4605 Use redis health checks for server testing
4606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4607 yes | no | yes | yes
4608 Arguments : none
4609
4610 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4611 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4612 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4613 find the "+PONG" response message.
4614
4615 Example :
4616 option redis-check
4617
4618 See also : "option httpchk"
4619
4620
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004621option smtpchk
4622option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4623 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4625 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004626 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004627 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4628 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4629 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4630
4631 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4632 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4633 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4634
4635 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4636 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4637 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4638 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4639 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4640 dead server.
4641
4642 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4643 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4644 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4645 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4646
4647 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4648 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4649 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4650 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4651 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4652
4653 Example :
4654 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4655
4656 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4657
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004659option socket-stats
4660no option socket-stats
4661
4662 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4664 yes | yes | yes | no
4665
4666 Arguments : none
4667
4668
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004669option splice-auto
4670no option splice-auto
4671 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4673 yes | yes | yes | yes
4674 Arguments : none
4675
4676 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4677 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4678 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4679 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004680 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004681 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4682 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4683 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4684 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4685
4686 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4687 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4688 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4689 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4690 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4691 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4692 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4693 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4694 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4695 keyword.
4696
4697 Example :
4698 option splice-auto
4699
4700 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4701 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4702
4703 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4704 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4705
4706
4707option splice-request
4708no option splice-request
4709 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4711 yes | yes | yes | yes
4712 Arguments : none
4713
4714 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004715 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004716 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4717 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4718 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4719 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4720
4721 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4722
4723 Example :
4724 option splice-request
4725
4726 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4727 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4728
4729 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4730 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4731
4732
4733option splice-response
4734no option splice-response
4735 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4737 yes | yes | yes | yes
4738 Arguments : none
4739
4740 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004741 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004742 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4743 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4744 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4745 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4746
4747 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4748
4749 Example :
4750 option splice-response
4751
4752 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4753 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4754
4755 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4756 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4757
4758
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004759option srvtcpka
4760no option srvtcpka
4761 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4763 yes | no | yes | yes
4764 Arguments : none
4765
4766 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4767 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4768 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4769 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4770
4771 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4772 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4773 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4774 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4775
4776 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4777 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4778 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4779 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4780 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4781
4782 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4783
4784 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4785 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4786 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4787
4788 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4789 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4790
4791 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4792
4793
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004794option ssl-hello-chk
4795 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4797 yes | no | yes | yes
4798 Arguments : none
4799
4800 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4801 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4802 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4803 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4804 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4805 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4806 hello message.
4807
4808 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4809 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4810 messages, which is appreciable.
4811
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004812 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4813 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4814 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004815
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004816 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4817
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004818
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004819option tcp-check
4820 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4821 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4822 yes | no | yes | yes
4823
4824 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4825 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4826
4827 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4828 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4829 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4830
4831 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentionned : this is
4832 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4833 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4834 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4835 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4836 only.
4837
4838 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentionned : this is used to test a banner.
4839 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4840 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4841 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4842 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4843
4844 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentionned : this is
4845 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4846 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
4847 the maching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
4848 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4849 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4850 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4851 the respective protocols.
4852 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4853 analysed.
4854
4855 Examples :
4856 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4857 option tcp-check
4858 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4859
4860 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4861 option tcp-check
4862 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4863
4864 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4865 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
4866 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 tims)
4867 option tcp-check
4868 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4869 tcp-check expect +PONG
4870 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4871 tcp-check expect string role:master
4872 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4873 tcp-check expect string +OK
4874
4875 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4876 (send many headers before analyzing)
4877 option tcp-check
4878 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4879 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4880 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4881 tcp-check send \r\n
4882 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4883
4884
4885 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4886
4887
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004888option tcp-smart-accept
4889no option tcp-smart-accept
4890 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4892 yes | yes | yes | no
4893 Arguments : none
4894
4895 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4896 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4897 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4898 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4899 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4900 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4901
4902 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4903 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4904 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4905 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4906
4907 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4908 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4909 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4910 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4911
4912 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4913 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4914 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4915
4916 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4917 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4918 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4919
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004920 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4921
4922
4923option tcp-smart-connect
4924no option tcp-smart-connect
4925 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4927 yes | no | yes | yes
4928 Arguments : none
4929
4930 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4931 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4932 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4933 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4934 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4935
4936 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4937 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4938 complex.
4939
4940 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4941 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4942 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4943
4944 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4945 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4946
4947 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4948
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004949
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004950option tcpka
4951 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4953 yes | yes | yes | yes
4954 Arguments : none
4955
4956 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4957 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4958 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4959 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4960
4961 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4962 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4963 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4964 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4965
4966 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4967 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4968 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4969 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4970 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4971
4972 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4973
4974 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4975 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4976 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4977 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4978 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4979 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4980 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4981 backends.
4982
4983 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4984
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004985
4986option tcplog
4987 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4989 yes | yes | yes | yes
4990 Arguments : none
4991
4992 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4993 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4994 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4995 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4996 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4997 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4998 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4999 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5000
5001 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005003 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005004
5005
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005006option transparent
5007no option transparent
5008 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005010 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005011 Arguments : none
5012
5013 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5014 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5015 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5016 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5017 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5018 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5019 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5020 appropriate server.
5021
5022 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5023 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5024
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005025 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005026 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005027
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005028
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005029persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005030persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005031 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5033 yes | no | yes | yes
5034 Arguments :
5035 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005036 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5037 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005038
5039 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5040 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5041 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5042 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5043 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5044 forwarded to this server.
5045
5046 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5047 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5048 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005049 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005050 a single "listen" section.
5051
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005052 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5053 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5054 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5055
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005056 Example :
5057 listen tse-farm
5058 bind :3389
5059 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5060 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5061 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5062 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5063 persist rdp-cookie
5064 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005065 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005066 balance rdp-cookie
5067 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5068 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5069
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005070 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5071 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005072
5073
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005074rate-limit sessions <rate>
5075 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5077 yes | yes | yes | no
5078 Arguments :
5079 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5080 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5081
5082 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5083 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5084 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5085 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5086 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5087 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5088
5089 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5090 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5091 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5092 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5093
5094 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5095 listen smtp
5096 mode tcp
5097 bind :25
5098 rate-limit sessions 10
5099 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5100
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005101 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5102 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5103 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005104
5105 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5106
5107
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005108redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5109redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5110redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005111 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5113 no | yes | yes | yes
5114
5115 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005116 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005117
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005118 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005119 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005120 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5121 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5122 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005123
5124 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5125 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5126 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5127 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5128 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005129 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5130 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5131 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5132 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005133
5134 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5135 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5136 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5137 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5138 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5139 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
5140 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
5141 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005142 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5143 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5144 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005145
5146 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005147 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5148 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5149 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5150 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5151 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5152 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5153 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5154 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005155
5156 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5157 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5158
5159 - "drop-query"
5160 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5161 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5162 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5163 with a location-type redirect.
5164
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005165 - "append-slash"
5166 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5167 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5168 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5169 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5170
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005171 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5172 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5173 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5174 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5175 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5176 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5177 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5178
5179 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5180 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5181 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5182 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5183 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5184 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5185 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005186
5187 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5188 acl clear dst_port 80
5189 acl secure dst_port 8080
5190 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005191 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005192 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005193 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5194
5195 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005196 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5197 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5198 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005199 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005200
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005201 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5202 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5203 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5204
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005205 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005206 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005207
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005208 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5209 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5210 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005212 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005213
5214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005215redisp (deprecated)
5216redispatch (deprecated)
5217 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5218 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5219 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005220 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005221
5222 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5223 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5224 be able to access the service anymore.
5225
5226 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5227 redistribute them to a working server.
5228
5229 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5230 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5231 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005233 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5234 "option redispatch" instead.
5235
5236 See also : "option redispatch"
5237
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005238
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005239reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005240 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5242 no | yes | yes | yes
5243 Arguments :
5244 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5245 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005246 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005247
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005248 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5249 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5250
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005251 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5252 the last header of an HTTP request.
5253
5254 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5255 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5256 responses.
5257
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005258 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5259 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5260 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5261
5262 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5263 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005264
5265
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005266reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5267reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005268 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5270 no | yes | yes | yes
5271 Arguments :
5272 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5273 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5274 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5275 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5276 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5277 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5278 ignores case.
5279
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005280 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5281 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5282
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005283 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5284 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5285 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5286 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005287 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005288
5289 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5290 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5291
5292 Example :
5293 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5294 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5295 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5296
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005297 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5298 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005299
5300
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005301reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5302reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005303 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5305 no | yes | yes | yes
5306 Arguments :
5307 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5308 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5309 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5310 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5311 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5312 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5313
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005314 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5315 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5316
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005317 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5318 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5319 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5320 next servers.
5321
5322 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5323 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5324 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5325
5326 Example :
5327 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5328 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5329 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5330
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005331 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5332 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005333
5334
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005335reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5336reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005337 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5339 no | yes | yes | yes
5340 Arguments :
5341 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5342 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5343 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5344 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5345 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5346 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5347 case.
5348
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005349 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5350 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5351
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005352 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5353 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5354 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5355 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005356 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005357
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005358 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005359 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005360 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005361
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005362 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5363 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5364
5365 Example :
5366 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5367 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5368 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5369
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005370 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5371 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005372
5373
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005374reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5375reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005376 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5378 no | yes | yes | yes
5379 Arguments :
5380 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5381 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5382 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5383 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5384 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5385 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5386 case.
5387
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005388 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5389 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5390
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005391 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5392 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5393 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5394 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5395
5396 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5397 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5398
5399 Example :
5400 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5401 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5402 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5403 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5404
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005405 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5406 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005407
5408
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005409reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5410reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005411 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5413 no | yes | yes | yes
5414 Arguments :
5415 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5416 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5417 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5418 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5419 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5420 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5421
5422 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5423 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5424 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5425 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005426 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005427
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005428 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5429 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5430
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005431 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5432 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5433 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5434
5435 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5436 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5437 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5438 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5439 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5440
5441 Example :
5442 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005443 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005444 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5445 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5446
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005447 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5448 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005449
5450
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005451reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5452reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005453 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5455 no | yes | yes | yes
5456 Arguments :
5457 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5458 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5459 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5460 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5461 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5462 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5463 ignores case.
5464
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005465 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5466 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5467
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005468 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5469 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005470 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5471 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5472 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005473 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5474 not set.
5475
5476 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5477 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5478 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5479 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5480 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5481
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005482 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005483 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5484 # block all others.
5485 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5486 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5487
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005488 # block bad guys
5489 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5490 reqitarpit . if badguys
5491
5492 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5493 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005494
5495
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005496retries <value>
5497 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5498 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5499 yes | no | yes | yes
5500 Arguments :
5501 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5502 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5503 default value is 3.
5504
5505 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5506 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5507 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5508
5509 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5510 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5511
5512 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5513 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5514
5515 See also : "option redispatch"
5516
5517
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005518rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005519 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5521 no | yes | yes | yes
5522 Arguments :
5523 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5524 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005525 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005526
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005527 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5528 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5529
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005530 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5531 the last header of an HTTP response.
5532
5533 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5534 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5535 responses.
5536
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005537 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5538 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005539
5540
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005541rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5542rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005543 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5545 no | yes | yes | yes
5546 Arguments :
5547 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5548 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5549 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5550 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5551 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5552 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5553 ignores case.
5554
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005555 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5556 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5557
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005558 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5559 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005560 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005561 client.
5562
5563 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5564 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5565 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5566
5567 Example :
5568 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005569 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005570
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005571 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5572 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005573
5574
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005575rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5576rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005577 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5579 no | yes | yes | yes
5580 Arguments :
5581 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5582 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5583 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5584 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5585 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5586 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5587 ignores case.
5588
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005589 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5590 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5591
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005592 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5593 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5594 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5595 case-sensitive.
5596
5597 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005598 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5599 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5600 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005601
5602 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5603 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5604
5605 Example :
5606 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5607 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5608
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005609 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5610 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005611
5612
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005613rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5614rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005615 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5617 no | yes | yes | yes
5618 Arguments :
5619 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5620 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5621 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5622 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5623 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5624 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5625 ignores case.
5626
5627 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5628 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5629 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5630 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005631 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005632
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005633 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5634 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5635
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005636 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5637 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5638 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5639
5640 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5641 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5642 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5643 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5644 are not case-sensitive.
5645
5646 Example :
5647 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5648 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5649
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005650 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5651 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005652
5653
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005654server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005655 Declare a server in a backend
5656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5657 no | no | yes | yes
5658 Arguments :
5659 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005660 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005661 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005662
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005663 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5664 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5665 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5666 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005667 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5668 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5669 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5670 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5671 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005672 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5673 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5674 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5675 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5676 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5677 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5678 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005679 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5680 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5681 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5682 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005683
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005684 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005685 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5686 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5687 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5688 adding this value to the client's port.
5689
5690 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5691 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005692 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005693
5694 Examples :
5695 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5696 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005697 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005698 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5699 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5700 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005701
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005702 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5703 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005704
5705
5706source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005707source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005708source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005709 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5711 yes | no | yes | yes
5712 Arguments :
5713 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5714 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005715
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005716 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005717 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5718 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5719 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5720 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5721 supported prefixes are :
5722 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5723 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5724 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005725 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5726 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5727 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5728 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005729
5730 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5731 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005732 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5733 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5734 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005735
5736 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5737 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5738 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5739 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5740 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5741 <addr>.
5742
5743 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5744 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5745 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5746 port.
5747
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005748 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5749 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5750 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5751 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005752 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005753 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5754 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5755 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5756 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5757 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5758 HTTP header.
5759
5760 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5761 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005762 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005763 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5764 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5765 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5766 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5767 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5768 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5769 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5770
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005771 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5772 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5773 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5774 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5775 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5776 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5777
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005778 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5779 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5780 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5781 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5782
5783 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5784 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5785 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5786 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5787 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5788 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5789
5790 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5791 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5792 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5793 there are two methods :
5794
5795 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5796 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5797 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5798 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5799 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5800 of the client ranges may be used.
5801
5802 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5803 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5804 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5805 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5806 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5807 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5808 same session.
5809
5810 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5811 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5812 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5813 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5814 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5815 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5816
5817 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5818 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5819 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005820 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005821
5822 Examples :
5823 backend private
5824 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5825 source 192.168.1.200
5826
5827 backend transparent_ssl1
5828 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5829 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5830
5831 backend transparent_ssl2
5832 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5833 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5834 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5835
5836 backend transparent_ssl3
5837 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5838 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5839 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5840
5841 backend transparent_smtp
5842 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5843 # with Tproxy version 4.
5844 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5845
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005846 backend transparent_http
5847 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5848 # proxy.
5849 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5850
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005851 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005852 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5853
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005854
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005855srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5856 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5858 yes | no | yes | yes
5859 Arguments :
5860 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5861 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5862 as explained at the top of this document.
5863
5864 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5865 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5866 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5867 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5868 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5869 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5870 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5871
5872 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5873 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5874 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5875 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5876 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005877 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005878 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005879 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005880
5881 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5882 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5883 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5884 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5885 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5886 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5887
5888 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5889 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5890
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005891 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5892 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005893
5894
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005895stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5896 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5898 no | no | yes | yes
5899
5900 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5901 matched.
5902
5903 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5904 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5905
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005906 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5907 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5908 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5909
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005910 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5911 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5912 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5913 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005914
5915 Example :
5916 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5917 backend stats_localhost
5918 stats enable
5919 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5920
5921 Example :
5922 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5923 backend stats_auth
5924 stats enable
5925 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5926 stats admin if TRUE
5927
5928 Example :
5929 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5930 userlist stats-auth
5931 group admin users admin
5932 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5933 group readonly users haproxy
5934 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5935
5936 backend stats_auth
5937 stats enable
5938 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5939 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5940 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5941 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5942
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005943 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5944 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5945 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005946
5947
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005948stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5949 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5951 yes | no | yes | yes
5952 Arguments :
5953 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5954
5955 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5956
5957 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5958 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5959 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5960 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5961 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5962 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5963
5964 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5965 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5966 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005967 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005968
5969 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5970 report using "stats scope".
5971
5972 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5973 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5974 unobvious parameters.
5975
5976 Example :
5977 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5978 backend public_www
5979 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5980 stats enable
5981 stats hide-version
5982 stats scope .
5983 stats uri /admin?stats
5984 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5985 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5986 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5987
5988 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5989 backend private_monitoring
5990 stats enable
5991 stats uri /admin?stats
5992 stats refresh 5s
5993
5994 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5995
5996
5997stats enable
5998 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6000 yes | no | yes | yes
6001 Arguments : none
6002
6003 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6004 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6005 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6006 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6007 - stats auth : no authentication
6008 - stats scope : no restriction
6009
6010 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6011 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6012 unobvious parameters.
6013
6014 Example :
6015 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6016 backend public_www
6017 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6018 stats enable
6019 stats hide-version
6020 stats scope .
6021 stats uri /admin?stats
6022 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6023 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6024 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6025
6026 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6027 backend private_monitoring
6028 stats enable
6029 stats uri /admin?stats
6030 stats refresh 5s
6031
6032 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6033
6034
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006035stats hide-version
6036 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6038 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006039 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006040
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006041 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6042 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6043 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6044 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6045 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6046 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006047
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006048 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6049 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6050 unobvious parameters.
6051
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006052 Example :
6053 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6054 backend public_www
6055 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006056 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006057 stats hide-version
6058 stats scope .
6059 stats uri /admin?stats
6060 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6061 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6062 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006063
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006064 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6065 backend private_monitoring
6066 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006067 stats uri /admin?stats
6068 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006069
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006070 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006071
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006072
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006073stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6074 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6075 Access control for statistics
6076
6077 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6078 no | no | yes | yes
6079
6080 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6081 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6082 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6083 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6084 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6085 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6086
6087 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6088 instance.
6089
6090 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6091 about ACL usage.
6092
6093
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006094stats realm <realm>
6095 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6097 yes | no | yes | yes
6098 Arguments :
6099 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6100 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6101 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6102
6103 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6104 using a backslash ('\').
6105
6106 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6107 only related to authentication.
6108
6109 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6110 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6111 unobvious parameters.
6112
6113 Example :
6114 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6115 backend public_www
6116 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6117 stats enable
6118 stats hide-version
6119 stats scope .
6120 stats uri /admin?stats
6121 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6122 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6123 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6124
6125 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6126 backend private_monitoring
6127 stats enable
6128 stats uri /admin?stats
6129 stats refresh 5s
6130
6131 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6132
6133
6134stats refresh <delay>
6135 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6137 yes | no | yes | yes
6138 Arguments :
6139 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6140 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6141 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6142 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6143 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6144 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6145
6146 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6147 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6148 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6149 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6150
6151 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6152 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6153 unobvious parameters.
6154
6155 Example :
6156 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6157 backend public_www
6158 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6159 stats enable
6160 stats hide-version
6161 stats scope .
6162 stats uri /admin?stats
6163 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6164 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6165 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6166
6167 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6168 backend private_monitoring
6169 stats enable
6170 stats uri /admin?stats
6171 stats refresh 5s
6172
6173 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6174
6175
6176stats scope { <name> | "." }
6177 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6179 yes | no | yes | yes
6180 Arguments :
6181 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6182 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6183 section in which the statement appears.
6184
6185 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6186 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6187 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6188 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6189 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6190 exists.
6191
6192 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6193 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6194 unobvious parameters.
6195
6196 Example :
6197 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6198 backend public_www
6199 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6200 stats enable
6201 stats hide-version
6202 stats scope .
6203 stats uri /admin?stats
6204 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6205 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6206 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6207
6208 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6209 backend private_monitoring
6210 stats enable
6211 stats uri /admin?stats
6212 stats refresh 5s
6213
6214 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6215
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006216
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006217stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006218 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6220 yes | no | yes | yes
6221
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006222 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006223 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6224
6225 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6226 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6227
6228 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6229 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006230 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006231
6232 Example :
6233 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6234 backend private_monitoring
6235 stats enable
6236 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6237 stats uri /admin?stats
6238 stats refresh 5s
6239
6240 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6241 global section.
6242
6243
6244stats show-legends
6245 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
6246 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6247 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6248 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6249 - IP (socket, server)
6250 - cookie (backend, server)
6251
6252 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6253 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006254 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006255
6256 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6257
6258
6259stats show-node [ <name> ]
6260 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6262 yes | no | yes | yes
6263 Arguments:
6264 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6265 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6266
6267 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6268 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006269 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006270
6271 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6272 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6273 unobvious parameters.
6274
6275 Example:
6276 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6277 backend private_monitoring
6278 stats enable
6279 stats show-node Europe-1
6280 stats uri /admin?stats
6281 stats refresh 5s
6282
6283 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6284 section.
6285
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006286
6287stats uri <prefix>
6288 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6290 yes | no | yes | yes
6291 Arguments :
6292 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6293 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6294 query string.
6295
6296 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6297 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6298 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6299 possible to reach it in the application.
6300
6301 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006302 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006303 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6304 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6305 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6306 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6307
6308 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6309 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6310 an address or a port to statistics only.
6311
6312 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6313 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6314 unobvious parameters.
6315
6316 Example :
6317 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6318 backend public_www
6319 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6320 stats enable
6321 stats hide-version
6322 stats scope .
6323 stats uri /admin?stats
6324 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6325 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6326 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6327
6328 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6329 backend private_monitoring
6330 stats enable
6331 stats uri /admin?stats
6332 stats refresh 5s
6333
6334 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6335
6336
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006337stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6338 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006340 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006341
6342 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006343 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006344 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6345 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6346 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6347
6348 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6349 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6350 the "stick-table" statement.
6351
6352 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6353 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6354 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6355 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6356 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6357
6358 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6359 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6360 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6361 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6362 transformation rules.
6363
6364 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6365 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6366 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6367 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6368 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6369 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6370 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6371
6372 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6373 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6374 ACL based conditions.
6375
6376 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6377 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6378 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6379 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6380
6381 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6382 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6383 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6384 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6385
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006386 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6387 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6388 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6389
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006390 Example :
6391 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6392 # last 30 minutes
6393 backend pop
6394 mode tcp
6395 balance roundrobin
6396 stick store-request src
6397 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6398 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6399 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6400
6401 backend smtp
6402 mode tcp
6403 balance roundrobin
6404 stick match src table pop
6405 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6406 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6407
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006408 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6409 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006410
6411
6412stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6413 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6415 no | no | yes | yes
6416
6417 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6418 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6419 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6420 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6421
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006422 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6423 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6424 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6425
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006426 Examples :
6427 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006428 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006429
6430 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6431 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6432 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6433
6434
6435 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6436 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6437 backend http
6438 mode http
6439 balance roundrobin
6440 stick on src table https
6441 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6442 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6443 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6444
6445 backend https
6446 mode tcp
6447 balance roundrobin
6448 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6449 stick on src
6450 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6451 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6452
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006453 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006454
6455
6456stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6457 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6459 no | no | yes | yes
6460
6461 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006462 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006463 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6464 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6465 server is selected.
6466
6467 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6468 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6469 the "stick-table" statement.
6470
6471 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6472 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6473 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6474 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6475 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6476 address.
6477
6478 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6479 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6480 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6481 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6482 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6483 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6484 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6485 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6486 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6487 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6488
6489 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6490 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6491 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6492 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6493 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6494 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6495 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6496
6497 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6498 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6499 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6500 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6501
6502 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6503 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6504 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6505 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6506 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6507 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006508 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6509 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6510 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6511 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6512 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6513 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006514
6515 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6516 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6517 the request.
6518
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006519 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6520 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6521 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6522
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006523 Example :
6524 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6525 # last 30 minutes
6526 backend pop
6527 mode tcp
6528 balance roundrobin
6529 stick store-request src
6530 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6531 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6532 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6533
6534 backend smtp
6535 mode tcp
6536 balance roundrobin
6537 stick match src table pop
6538 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6539 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6540
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006541 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6542 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006543
6544
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006545stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006546 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6547 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006548 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006550 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006551
6552 Arguments :
6553 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6554 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6555 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6556 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6557
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006558 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6559 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6560 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6561 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6562
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006563 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6564 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6565 instance.
6566
6567 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6568 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6569 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6570 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6571 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6572 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006573 to 32 characters.
6574
6575 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6576 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6577 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6578 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6579 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6580 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006581
6582 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006583 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6584 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006585 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6586 increase.
6587
6588 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006589 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6590 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6591 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006592
6593 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6594 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6595 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6596 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6597 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6598 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6599 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6600 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6601 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6602 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6603 parameter (see below).
6604
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006605 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6606 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6607 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6608 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6609 soft restart.
6610
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006611 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6612
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006613 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6614 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6615 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6616 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6617 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006618 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006619 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6620 if not expiration delay is specified.
6621
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006622 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6623 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6624 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6625 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006626 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6627 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6628 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6629 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6630 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6631 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6632 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6633 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6634 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6635 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6636 types and their arguments.
6637
6638 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6639 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6640 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6641 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6642
6643 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6644 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6645 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6646 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6647
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006648 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6649 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6650 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6651 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6652 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6653 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6654
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006655 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6656 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6657 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6658 they were received.
6659
6660 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6661 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6662 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6663 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6664 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6665
6666 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6667 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6668 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6669 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6670 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6671
6672 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6673 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6674 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6675
6676 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6677 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6678 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6679 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6680 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6681
6682 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6683 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6684 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6685 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6686 the client side.
6687
6688 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6689 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6690 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6691 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6692 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6693 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6694 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6695
6696 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6697 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6698 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6699 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6700 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6701 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6702 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6703
6704 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6705 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6706 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6707 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6708 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6709 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6710
6711 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6712 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6713 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6714 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6715
6716 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6717 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6718 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6719 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6720 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6721 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6722 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6723 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6724 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6725 recommended for better fairness.
6726
6727 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6728 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6729 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6730 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6731
6732 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6733 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6734 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6735 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6736 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6737 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6738 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6739 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6740 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6741 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006742
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006743 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6744 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006745 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6746 reference it.
6747
6748 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6749 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6750 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6751 as an exclusive stickiness.
6752
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006753 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6754 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6755 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6756 something that can be ignored.
6757
6758 Example:
6759 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6760 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6761 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6762 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6763
6764 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006765 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006766
6767
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006768stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6769 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6771 no | no | yes | yes
6772
6773 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006774 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006775 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6776 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6777 server is selected.
6778
6779 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6780 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6781 the "stick-table" statement.
6782
6783 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6784 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6785 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6786 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6787
6788 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6789 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6790 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6791 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6792 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6793 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006794 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006795 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6796 rules.
6797
6798 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6799 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6800 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6801 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6802 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6803 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6804 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6805
6806 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6807 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6808 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6809 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6810
6811 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6812 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6813 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6814 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6815 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6816 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006817 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6818 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6819 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6820 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6821 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6822 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6823 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6824 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6825 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006826
6827 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6828
6829 Example :
6830 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6831 backend https
6832 mode tcp
6833 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006834 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006835 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006836
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006837 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6838 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6839
6840 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6841 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6842 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6843
6844 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6845 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006846
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006847 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6848 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6849 # at offset 44.
6850
6851 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6852 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6853
6854 # Learn on response if server hello.
6855 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006856
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006857 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6858 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6859
6860 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6861 extraction.
6862
6863
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006864tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6865 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6867 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006868 Arguments :
6869 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006870 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6871 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006872
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006873 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006874
6875 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6876 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006877 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6878 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6879 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6880 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6881 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6882 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006883
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006884 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6885 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6886 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6887 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006888
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006889 Three types of actions are supported :
6890 - accept :
6891 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6892 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6893 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006894
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006895 - reject :
6896 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6897 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6898 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6899 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6900 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6901 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6902 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6903 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6904 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6905 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6906 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6907 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006908
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006909 - expect-proxy layer4 :
6910 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
6911 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
6912 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
6913 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
6914 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
6915 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
6916 hosts.
6917
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006918 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006919 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6920 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6921 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006922 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6923 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006924 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006925 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
6926 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
6927 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
6928 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
6929 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006930
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006931 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006932 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006933 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006934 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6935 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6936 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6937 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006938
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006939 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6940 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6941 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6942 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006943
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006944 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6945 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6946 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6947 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6948 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006949 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6950 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6951 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6952 layer7 information is extracted.
6953
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006954 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6955 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6956 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6957 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6958 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006959
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006960 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6961 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6962 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006963
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006964 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6965 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6966 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006967
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006968 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006969 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006970 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006971
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006972 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6973 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6974 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006975
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006976 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006977 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6978 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006979
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006980 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
6981
6982 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
6983
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006984 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6985
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006986 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006987
6988
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006989tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6990 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006992 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006993 Arguments :
6994 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006995 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6996 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006997 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006998
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006999 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007000
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007001 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7002 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7003 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7004 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7005 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007006
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007007 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7008 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7009 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7010 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007011 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7012 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7013 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7014 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7015 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7016 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
7017 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditionned by an
7018 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007019
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007020 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7021 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7022 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7023 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007024
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007025 Three types of actions are supported :
7026 - accept :
7027 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007028 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007029
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007030 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7031 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007032
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007033 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7034 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7035 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7036 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7037 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7038 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007039
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007040 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007041 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7042 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007043
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007044 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007045 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7046 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7047 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7048 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007049 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7050 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7051 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007052
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007053 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7054 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7055 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7056 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7057
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007058 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007059 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7060 # and reject everything else.
7061 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7062 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007063 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007064 tcp-request content reject
7065
7066 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007067 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7068 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7069 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007070 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007071
7072 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7073 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7074 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007075 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007076 tcp-request content reject
7077
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007078 Example:
7079 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7080 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007081 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007082
7083 Example:
7084 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7085 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007086 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007087
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007088 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7089 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7090
7091 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007092 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007093 # protecting all our sites
7094 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007095 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7096 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007097 ...
7098 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7099
7100 backend http_dynamic
7101 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007102 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007103 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007104 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7105 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7106 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007107 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007109 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007110
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007111 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007112
7113
7114tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7115 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007117 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007118 Arguments :
7119 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7120 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7121 as explained at the top of this document.
7122
7123 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7124 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7125 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7126 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7127 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7128
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007129 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7130 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7131 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7132 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7133
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007134 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7135 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007136 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007137 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007138 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7139 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7140 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7141 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007142
7143 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7144 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7145 it pass through unaffected.
7146
7147 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7148 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7149 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007150 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007151 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7152 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007153 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7154 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7155 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007156
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007157 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007158 "timeout client".
7159
7160
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007161tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7162 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7164 no | no | yes | yes
7165 Arguments :
7166 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007167 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007168
7169 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7170
7171 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7172 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7173 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007174 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7175 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007176
7177 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7178
7179 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7180 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7181 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7182 inserted.
7183
7184 Two types of actions are supported :
7185 - accept :
7186 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7187 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7188 the rules evaluation.
7189
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007190 - close :
7191 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7192 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7193 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7194 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7195 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7196 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
7197 connections which take signifiant resources on servers with certain
7198 protocols.
7199
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007200 - reject :
7201 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7202 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007203 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007204
7205 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7206 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7207 for changing the default action to a reject.
7208
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007209 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7210 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7211 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7212 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007213 period.
7214
7215 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7216
7217 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7218
7219
7220tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7221 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7223 no | no | yes | yes
7224 Arguments :
7225 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7226 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7227 as explained at the top of this document.
7228
7229 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7230
7231
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007232timeout check <timeout>
7233 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7234 established.
7235
7236 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7237 yes | no | yes | yes
7238 Arguments:
7239 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7240 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7241 as explained at the top of this document.
7242
7243 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7244 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7245 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7246 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007247 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7248 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7249 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007250
7251 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7252 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7253
7254 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7255 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007256 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007257
7258 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7259 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7260 forget about it.
7261
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007262 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7263 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007264
7265
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007266timeout client <timeout>
7267timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7268 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7270 yes | yes | yes | no
7271 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007272 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007273 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7274 as explained at the top of this document.
7275
7276 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7277 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7278 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7279 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7280 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7281 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7282 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7283 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007284 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007285 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007286 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7287 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
7288 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007289
7290 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7291 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7292 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7293 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7294 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7295 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7296
7297 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7298 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7299 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7300
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007301 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007302
7303
7304timeout connect <timeout>
7305timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7306 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7308 yes | no | yes | yes
7309 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007310 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007311 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7312 as explained at the top of this document.
7313
7314 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007315 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007316 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007317 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007318 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7319 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007320
7321 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7322 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7323 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7324 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7325 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7326 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7327
7328 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7329 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7330 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7331
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007332 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7333 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007334
7335
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007336timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7337 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7339 yes | yes | yes | yes
7340 Arguments :
7341 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7342 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7343 as explained at the top of this document.
7344
7345 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7346 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7347 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7348 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7349 once the request has started to present itself.
7350
7351 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7352 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7353 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7354 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7355 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7356
7357 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7358 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7359 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7360 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7361
7362 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7363 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7364 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7365 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7366 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007367 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007368
7369 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7370 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7371 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7372 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7373
7374 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7375
7376
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007377timeout http-request <timeout>
7378 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007380 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007381 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007382 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007383 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7384 as explained at the top of this document.
7385
7386 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7387 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7388 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7389 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7390 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7391 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7392 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7393 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7394
7395 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7396 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007397 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7398 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007399
7400 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7401 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7402 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7403 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7404 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7405
7406 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007407 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7408 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7409 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007410
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007411 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007412
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007413
7414timeout queue <timeout>
7415 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7417 yes | no | yes | yes
7418 Arguments :
7419 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7420 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7421 as explained at the top of this document.
7422
7423 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7424 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7425 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7426 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7427 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7428
7429 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7430 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7431 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7432 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7433
7434 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7435
7436
7437timeout server <timeout>
7438timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7439 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7441 yes | no | yes | yes
7442 Arguments :
7443 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7444 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7445 as explained at the top of this document.
7446
7447 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7448 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7449 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7450 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7451 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7452 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7453 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7454
7455 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7456 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7457 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7458 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7459 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007460 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007461 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007462 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7463 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7464 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7465 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007466
7467 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7468 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7469 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7470 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7471 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7472 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7473
7474 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7475 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7476 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7477
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007478 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007479
7480
7481timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007482 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7484 yes | yes | yes | yes
7485 Arguments :
7486 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7487 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7488 as explained at the top of this document.
7489
7490 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7491 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7492 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7493
7494 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7495 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7496 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7497 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007498 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007499
7500 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7501
7502
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007503timeout tunnel <timeout>
7504 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7506 yes | no | yes | yes
7507 Arguments :
7508 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7509 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7510 as explained at the top of this document.
7511
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007512 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007513 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7514 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7515 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7516 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7517 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7518 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7519 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7520 specified.
7521
7522 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7523 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7524 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7525 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7526 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7527
7528 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7529 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7530 forget about it.
7531
7532 Example :
7533 defaults http
7534 option http-server-close
7535 timeout connect 5s
7536 timeout client 30s
7537 timeout client 30s
7538 timeout server 30s
7539 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7540
7541 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7542
7543
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007544transparent (deprecated)
7545 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007547 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007548 Arguments : none
7549
7550 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7551 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7552 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7553 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7554 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7555 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7556 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7557 appropriate server.
7558
7559 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7560
7561 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7562 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7563
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007564 See also: "option transparent"
7565
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007566unique-id-format <string>
7567 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7569 yes | yes | yes | no
7570 Arguments :
7571 <string> is a log-format string.
7572
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007573 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7574 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7575 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7576 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007577
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007578 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7579 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7580 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7581 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7582 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7583 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7584 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7585 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007586
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007587 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7588 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007589
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007590 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007591
7592 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7593
7594 will generate:
7595
7596 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7597
7598 See also: "unique-id-header"
7599
7600unique-id-header <name>
7601 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7603 yes | yes | yes | no
7604 Arguments :
7605 <name> is the name of the header.
7606
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007607 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7608 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007609
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007610 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007611
7612 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7613 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7614
7615 will generate:
7616
7617 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7618
7619 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007620
7621use_backend <backend> if <condition>
7622use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007623 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7625 no | yes | yes | no
7626 Arguments :
7627 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
7628
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007629 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007630
7631 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7632 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7633 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007634 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7635 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7636 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7637 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007638
7639 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7640 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7641 assign the backend.
7642
7643 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7644 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7645 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7646 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7647 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7648 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7649
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007650 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007651 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007652 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7653 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7654 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7655
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007656 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007657
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007658
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007659use-server <server> if <condition>
7660use-server <server> unless <condition>
7661 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7663 no | no | yes | yes
7664 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007665 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007666
7667 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7668
7669 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7670 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7671 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7672
7673 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7674 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7675 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7676 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7677 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7678 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7679 matches will assign the server.
7680
7681 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7682 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7683 with the next rules until one matches.
7684
7685 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7686 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7687 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7688 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7689
7690 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7691 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7692 stripped.
7693
7694 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7695 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7696 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7697 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7698
7699 Example :
7700 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7701 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7702 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7703 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7704 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7705 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7706 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7707 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7708 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7709
7710 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7711
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007712
77135. Bind and Server options
7714--------------------------
7715
7716The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7717depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7718settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7719written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7720described in this section.
7721
7722
77235.1. Bind options
7724-----------------
7725
7726The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7727as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7728no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7729parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7730while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7731provided immediately after the setting name.
7732
7733The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7734
7735accept-proxy
7736 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7737 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7738 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7739 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7740 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7741 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7742 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7743 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7744 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007745 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7746 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007747
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007748alpn <protocols>
7749 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7750 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7751 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7752 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7753 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7754 initial NPN extension.
7755
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007756backlog <backlog>
7757 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7758 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7759
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007760ecdhe <named curve>
7761 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007762 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7763 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007764
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007765ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007766 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7767 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7768 client's certificate.
7769
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007770ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7771 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7772 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7773 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7774 error is ignored.
7775
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007776ciphers <ciphers>
7777 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7778 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7779 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7780 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7781 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7782
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007783crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007784 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7785 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7786 to verify client's certificate.
7787
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007788crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007789 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7790 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7791 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7792 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7793 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7794 file.
7795
7796 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7797 are loaded.
7798
7799 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7800 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7801 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7802 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7803 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7804 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7805 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7806 www.sub.example.org).
7807
7808 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7809 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7810 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7811 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7812 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7813
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007814 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007815
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007816 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7817 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
7818 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires a intermediate CA (for
7819 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7820 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7821 clients).
7822
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007823crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007824 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7825 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
7826 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an error
7827 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007828
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007829crt-list <file>
7830 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007831 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7832 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007833
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007834 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007835
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007836 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7837 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7838 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7839 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7840 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7841 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7842 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7843 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007844
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007845defer-accept
7846 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7847 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7848 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7849 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7850 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7851 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7852 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7853 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7854 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7855 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7856 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7857
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007858force-sslv3
7859 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7860 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7861 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7862
7863force-tlsv10
7864 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7865 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7866
7867force-tlsv11
7868 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7869 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7870
7871force-tlsv12
7872 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7873 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7874
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007875gid <gid>
7876 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7877 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7878 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7879 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7880 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7881
7882group <group>
7883 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7884 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7885 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7886 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7887 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7888
7889id <id>
7890 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7891 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7892 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7893 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7894
7895interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007896 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7897 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7898 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7899 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7900 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7901 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7902 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007903
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007904level <level>
7905 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7906 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7907 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7908 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7909 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7910 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7911 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7912 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7913 counters).
7914 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7915 all counters).
7916
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007917maxconn <maxconn>
7918 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7919 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7920 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7921 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7922 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7923 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7924 eat all memory.
7925
7926mode <mode>
7927 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7928 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7929 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7930 UNIX sockets.
7931
7932mss <maxseg>
7933 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7934 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7935 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7936 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7937 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7938 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7939 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7940 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7941 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7942 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7943 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7944
7945name <name>
7946 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7947 page.
7948
7949nice <nice>
7950 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7951 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7952 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7953 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7954 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7955 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7956 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7957 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7958 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7959 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7960 one for an RDP socket.
7961
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007962no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007963 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7964 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7965 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007966 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7967 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007968
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007969no-tls-tickets
7970 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7971 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7972 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7973 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7974
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007975no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007976 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007977 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7978 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7979 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7980 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007981
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007982no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007983 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007984 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7985 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7986 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7987 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007988
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007989no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007990 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007991 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7992 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7993 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7994 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007995
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007996npn <protocols>
7997 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7998 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7999 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8000 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008001 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8002 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008003
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008004ssl
8005 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8006 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
8007 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8008 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8009 to deciphered contents.
8010
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008011strict-sni
8012 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8013 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8014 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8015 See the "crt" option for more information.
8016
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008017tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008018 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008019 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8020 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8021 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8022 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8023 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8024 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8025 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008026 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8027 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8028 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008029
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008030transparent
8031 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8032 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8033 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8034 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8035 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8036 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8037 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8038 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8039 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8040 so check for support with your vendor.
8041
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008042v4v6
8043 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8044 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8045 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8046 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
8047 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
8048
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008049v6only
8050 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8051 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8052 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008053 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8054 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008055
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008056uid <uid>
8057 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8058 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8059 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8060 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8061 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8062
8063user <user>
8064 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8065 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8066 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8067 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8068 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8069
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008070verify [none|optional|required]
8071 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8072 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8073 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8074 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8075 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008076 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8077 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8078 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8079 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008080
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020080815.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008082------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008083
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008084The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8085which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8086arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8087settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8088after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8089Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8090address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008092 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008093 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008094
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008095The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008096
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008097addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008098 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8099 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8100 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8101 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8102 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008103
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008104 Supported in default-server: No
8105
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008106agent-check
8107 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
8108 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
8109 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
8110 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
8111
8112 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
8113 e.g. "75%"
8114
8115 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8116 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8117
8118 * The string "drain".
8119
8120 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
8121 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
8122 persistence.
8123
8124 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
8125
8126 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
8127
8128 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
8129
8130 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8131
8132 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
8133
8134 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8135
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008136 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8137 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
8138 parameter.
8139
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008140 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
8141 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
8142
8143 Supported in default-server: No
8144
8145agent-inter <delay>
8146 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8147 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8148
8149 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8150 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8151 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8152 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8153 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8154 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8155 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8156 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8157 of backends use the same servers.
8158
8159 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8160
8161 Supported in default-server: Yes
8162
8163agent-port <port>
8164 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8165
8166 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8167
8168 Supported in default-server: Yes
8169
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008170backup
8171 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8172 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8173 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8174 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8175 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8176 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008177
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008178 Supported in default-server: No
8179
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008180ca-file <cafile>
8181 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8182 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8183 server's certificate.
8184
8185 Supported in default-server: No
8186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008187check
8188 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008189 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8190 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8191 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8192 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8193 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8194 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8195 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008196 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8197 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8198 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008199
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008200 Supported in default-server: No
8201
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008202check-send-proxy
8203 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8204 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8205 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8206 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8207 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8208 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8209 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8210
8211 Supported in default-server: No
8212
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008213check-ssl
8214 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8215 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8216 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8217 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
8218 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
8219 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8220 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8221 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8222 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8223
8224 Supported in default-server: No
8225
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008226ciphers <ciphers>
8227 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
8228 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
8229 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8230 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8231 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8232 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8233 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8234 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8235
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008236 Supported in default-server: No
8237
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008238cookie <value>
8239 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8240 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8241 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8242 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8243 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8244 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8245 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8246
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008247 Supported in default-server: No
8248
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008249crl-file <crlfile>
8250 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8251 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8252 to verify server's certificate.
8253
8254 Supported in default-server: No
8255
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008256crt <cert>
8257 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8258 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8259 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8260 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8261 certificate request.
8262
8263 Supported in default-server: No
8264
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008265disabled
8266 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8267 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8268 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8269 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8270 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8271
8272 Supported in default-server: No
8273
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008274error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008275 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8276 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8277 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008278
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008279 Supported in default-server: Yes
8280
8281 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008283fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008284 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8285 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8286 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008288 Supported in default-server: Yes
8289
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008290force-sslv3
8291 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8292 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8293 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8294
8295 Supported in default-server: No
8296
8297force-tlsv10
8298 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8299 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8300
8301 Supported in default-server: No
8302
8303force-tlsv11
8304 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8305 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8306
8307 Supported in default-server: No
8308
8309force-tlsv12
8310 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8311 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8312
8313 Supported in default-server: No
8314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008315id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008316 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8317 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8318 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008320 Supported in default-server: No
8321
8322inter <delay>
8323fastinter <delay>
8324downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008325 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8326 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8327 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8328 between checks depending on the server state :
8329
8330 Server state | Interval used
8331 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8332 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8333 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8334 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8335 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8336 or yet unchecked. |
8337 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8338 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8339 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008341 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8342 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8343 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8344 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008345 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8346 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8347 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8348 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8349 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008350
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008351 Supported in default-server: Yes
8352
8353maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008354 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8355 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8356 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8357 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8358 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8359 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8360 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8361 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008363 Supported in default-server: Yes
8364
8365maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008366 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8367 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8368 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8369 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8370 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8371 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8372 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008374 Supported in default-server: Yes
8375
8376minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008377 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8378 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8379 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8380 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8381 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8382 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008383 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008384 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008385
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008386 Supported in default-server: Yes
8387
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008388no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008389 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8390 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008391 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008392
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008393 Supported in default-server: No
8394
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008395no-tls-tickets
8396 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8397 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8398 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8399 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8400
8401 Supported in default-server: No
8402
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008403no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008404 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008405 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8406 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008407 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8408 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008409
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008410 Supported in default-server: No
8411
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008412no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008413 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008414 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8415 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008416 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8417 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008418
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008419 Supported in default-server: No
8420
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008421no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008422 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008423 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8424 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008425 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8426 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008427
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008428 Supported in default-server: No
8429
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008430non-stick
8431 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8432 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8433 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8434
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008435 Supported in default-server: No
8436
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008437observe <mode>
8438 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8439 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8440 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8441 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8442 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8443 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008444 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008445
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008446 Supported in default-server: No
8447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008448 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8449
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008450on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008451 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8452 Currently, four modes are available:
8453 - fastinter: force fastinter
8454 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8455 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8456 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8457 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8458
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008459 Supported in default-server: Yes
8460
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008461 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8462
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008463on-marked-down <action>
8464 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8465 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008466 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8467 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8468 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8469 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8470 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8471 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8472 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8473 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008474
8475 Actions are disabled by default
8476
8477 Supported in default-server: Yes
8478
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008479on-marked-up <action>
8480 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8481 Currently one action is available:
8482 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8483 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8484 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8485 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8486 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8487 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8488 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8489 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8490
8491 Actions are disabled by default
8492
8493 Supported in default-server: Yes
8494
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008495port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008496 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8497 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8498 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8499 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8500 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8501 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008503 Supported in default-server: Yes
8504
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008505redir <prefix>
8506 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8507 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8508 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8509 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8510 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8511 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8512 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8513 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008514 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008515 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8516 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8517 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8518 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8519 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8520
8521 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8522
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008523 Supported in default-server: No
8524
8525rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008526 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8527 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8528 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8529
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008530 Supported in default-server: Yes
8531
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008532send-proxy
8533 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8534 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8535 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8536 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8537 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8538 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8539 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8540 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8541 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008542 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8543 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8544 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8545 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8546 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008547
8548 Supported in default-server: No
8549
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008550slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008551 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8552 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8553 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8554 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8555 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8556 parameters :
8557
8558 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8559 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8560
8561 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8562 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8563 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8564 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8565
8566 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8567 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8568 seen as failed.
8569
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008570 Supported in default-server: Yes
8571
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008572source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008573source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008574source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008575 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8576 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8577 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8578 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8579
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008580 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8581 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8582 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8583 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8584 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8585 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8586 server.
8587
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008588 Supported in default-server: No
8589
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008590ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008591 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8592 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8593 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8594 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8595 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8596 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
8597 See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008598
8599 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008601track [<proxy>/]<server>
8602 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8603 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8604 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8605 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8606 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8607
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008608 Supported in default-server: No
8609
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008610verify [none|required]
8611 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01008612 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
8613 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
8614 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
8615 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008616 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8617 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8618 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008619
8620 Supported in default-server: No
8621
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008622verifyhost <hostname>
8623 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8624 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8625 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8626 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8627 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8628 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8629
8630 Supported in default-server: No
8631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008632weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008633 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8634 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8635 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008636 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8637 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8638 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8639 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8640 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8641 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008642
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008643 Supported in default-server: Yes
8644
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008645
86466. HTTP header manipulation
8647---------------------------
8648
8649In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8650response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8651request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8652which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008653against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008654
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008655If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
8656to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
8657but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
8658HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
8659stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
8660because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
8661a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
8662still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008664This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8665in section 4.2 :
8666
8667 - reqadd <string>
8668 - reqallow <search>
8669 - reqiallow <search>
8670 - reqdel <search>
8671 - reqidel <search>
8672 - reqdeny <search>
8673 - reqideny <search>
8674 - reqpass <search>
8675 - reqipass <search>
8676 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8677 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8678 - reqtarpit <search>
8679 - reqitarpit <search>
8680 - rspadd <string>
8681 - rspdel <search>
8682 - rspidel <search>
8683 - rspdeny <search>
8684 - rspideny <search>
8685 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8686 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8687
8688With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8689is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8690parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8691prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8692Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8693
8694 \t for a tab
8695 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8696 \n for a new line (LF)
8697 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8698 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8699 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8700 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8701 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8702
8703The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8704portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8705above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8706regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
87079 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8708is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8709
8710The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8711after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8712
8713Notes related to these keywords :
8714---------------------------------
8715 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8716 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8717 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8718
8719 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8720 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8721 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8722
8723 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8724 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8725 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8726 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8727 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8728
8729 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8730 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8731 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8732 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8733 useless headers before adding new ones.
8734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008735 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008736 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8737
8738 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8739 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8740 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8741
8742 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8743 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008744 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008745
8746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020087477. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8748----------------------------------
8749
8750Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8751client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8752The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8753these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8754but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8755data called patterns.
8756
8757
87587.1. ACL basics
8759---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008760
8761The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8762content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8763from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8764simple :
8765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008766 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008767 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008768 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8769 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008771The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8772adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008773
8774In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008776 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008777
8778This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8779Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8780and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008781an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
8782conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
8783as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
8784are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008785
8786ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8787'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8788which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8789
8790There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8791performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008793The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8794specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8795this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008796methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
8797ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008798
8799Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8800 - boolean
8801 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8802 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8803 - string
8804 - data block
8805
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008806Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
8807converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
8808would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
8809The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
8810which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
8811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008812The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8813 - boolean
8814 - integer or integer range
8815 - IP address / network
8816 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8817 - regular expression
8818 - hex block
8819
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008820The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8821
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008822 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8823 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008824 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008825 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008827The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8828read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8829if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8830lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8831will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8832beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8833a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8834lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8835exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8836
8837Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8838loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8839
8840 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8841
8842In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8843the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8844case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8845as well.
8846
8847The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8848sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8849do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8850methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8851is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8852obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8853followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8854default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8855that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8856string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8857
8858There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8859sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8860be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008861
8862 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
8863 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008864 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
8865 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
8866 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
8867 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008868
8869 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
8870 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008871 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008872
8873 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008874 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008875
8876 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008877 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008878
8879 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
8880 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
8881
8882 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
8883 binary or string samples.
8884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008885 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
8886 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008888 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
8889 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
8890 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008892 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
8893 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008895 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
8896 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008898 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
8899 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008901 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
8902 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008903 This may be used with binary or string samples.
8904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008905 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
8906 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
8907 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008908
8909For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
8910request, it is possible to do :
8911
8912 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
8913
8914In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
8915buffer, one would use the following acl :
8916
8917 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
8918
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008919On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
8920possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
8921
8922 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
8923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008924All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
8925criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
8926method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
8927to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
8928criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
8929the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008931If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
8932the mathing method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method. For
8933example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008935 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
8936 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
8937 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
8938 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008939
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008940
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008941The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008942and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
8943combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
8944the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008946 +-------------------------------------------------+
8947 | Input sample type |
8948 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8949 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
8950 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8951 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
8952 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008953 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008954 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008955 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008956 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008957 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008958 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008959 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008960 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008961 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008962 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008963 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008964 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008965 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008966 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008967 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008968 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008969 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008970 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008971 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008972 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008973 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008974 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8975 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
8976 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008977
8978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089797.1.1. Matching booleans
8980------------------------
8981
8982In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
8983Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
8984When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
8985that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
8986
8987Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
8988return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
8989"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
8990
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089927.1.2. Matching integers
8993------------------------
8994
8995Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
8996enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
8997to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
8998
8999Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9000matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9001lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009002
9003For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9004unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9005representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9006
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009007As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9008two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9009instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9010ranges and operators.
9011
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009012For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009013operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9014Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9015of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009017Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009018
9019 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9020 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9021 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9022 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9023 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9024
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009025For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009026
9027 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9028
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009029This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9030
9031 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9032
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020090347.1.3. Matching strings
9035-----------------------
9036
9037String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9038different forms :
9039
9040 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9041 patterns ;
9042
9043 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9044 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9045
9046 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9047 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9048
9049 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9050 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9051
9052 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9053 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9054 matches.
9055
9056 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9057 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9058 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009059
9060String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9061exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9062characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9063string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9064to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009065before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009066
9067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020090687.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9069---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009070
9071Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9072they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9073possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9074passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9075the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009076the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9077match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009078
9079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020090807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9081-------------------------------------
9082
9083It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9084not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9085a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9086to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9087digits may be used upper or lower case.
9088
9089Example :
9090 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9091 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9092
9093
90947.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9095---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009096
9097IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9098netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9099within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009100host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009101difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9102at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9103does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9104parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009105
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009106IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9107Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9108trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9109IPv6 patterns.
9110
9111HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9112following situations :
9113 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9114 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9115 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9116 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9117 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9118 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9119 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9120 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9121 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9122 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009124
91257.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9126----------------------------------
9127
9128Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9129combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9130
9131 - AND (implicit)
9132 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9133 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009135A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009137 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009139Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9140indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009142For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9143"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9144requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9145is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9146
9147 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9148 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9149 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9150 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9151
9152To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9153and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9154
9155 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9156 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9157 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9158 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9159
9160 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9161 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9162 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9163 use_backend www if host_www
9164
9165It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9166expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9167be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9168the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9169
9170 The following rule :
9171
9172 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9173 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9174
9175 Can also be written that way :
9176
9177 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9178
9179It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9180to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9181simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9182sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9183good use is the following :
9184
9185 With named ACLs :
9186
9187 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9188 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9189 monitor fail if site_dead
9190
9191 With anonymous ACLs :
9192
9193 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9194
9195See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9196
9197
91987.3. Fetching samples
9199---------------------
9200
9201Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9202against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9203sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9204ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9205of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9206available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9207
9208This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9209Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9210compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9211deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9212
9213The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9214matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9215method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9216indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9217
9218As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9219when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9220mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9221the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9222ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9223
9224Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9225multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9226when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9227incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9228are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9229is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9230all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9231
9232Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9233 - name
9234 - name(arg1)
9235 - name(arg1,arg2)
9236
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009237Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9238of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9239is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9240was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9241has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9242unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9243
9244These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9245sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9246the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9247support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009249The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009251 lower Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed
9252 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9253 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009255 upper Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed
9256 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9257 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009259 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for
9260 lookups and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within
9261 a certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9262 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9263 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9264
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009265 http_date([<offset>])
9266 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to
9267 a string representing this date in a format suitable for use
9268 in HTTP header fields. If an offset value is specified, then
9269 it is a number of seconds that is added to the date before the
9270 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit
9271 Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined
9272 with a positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the
9273 offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009274
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009275 map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9276 map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9277 map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9278 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type>
9279 matching method, and return the associated value converted to
9280 the type <output_type>. If the input value cannot be found in
9281 the <map_file>, the converter returns the <default_value>. If
9282 the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and acts
9283 as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is
9284 not set, it defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type>
9285 is not set, it defaults to "str". For convenience, the "map"
9286 keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a string to another
9287 string. The following array contains contains the list of all
9288 the map* converters.
9289
9290 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP
9291 addresses and strings are stored in trees, so the first of the
9292 finest match will be used. Other keys are stored in lists, so
9293 the first matching occurrence will be used.
9294
9295 +----+----------+---------+-------------+------------+
9296 | `-_ out | | | |
9297 | input `-_ | str | int | ip |
9298 | / match `-_ | | | |
9299 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9300 | str / str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip |
9301 | str / sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip |
9302 | str / dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip |
9303 | str / dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip |
9304 | str / end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip |
9305 | str / reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip |
9306 | int / int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip |
9307 | ip / ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip |
9308 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9309
9310 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start
9311 with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and
9312 spaces are stripped. The key is then the first "word" (series
9313 of non-space/tabs characters), and the value is what follows
9314 this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9315 trailing spaces/tabs.
9316
9317 Example :
9318
9319 # this is a comment and is ignored
9320 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9321 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9322 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9323 | | | `----------- value
9324 | | `--------------------- middle spaces ignored
9325 | `---------------------------- key
9326 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093287.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
9329--------------------------------------------
9330
9331A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9332not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9333"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9334The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9335
9336always_false : boolean
9337 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9338 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9339
9340always_true : boolean
9341 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9342 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9343
9344avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009345 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009346 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9347 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9348 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9349 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9350 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9351 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9352 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9353 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9354 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9355 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9356 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9357 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9358 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009360be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009361 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9362 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9363 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9364 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9365 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009367be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9368 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9369 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9370 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9371 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9372 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9373 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009374
9375 Example :
9376 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9377 backend dynamic
9378 mode http
9379 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9380 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009382connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9383 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
9384 still available in the backend, by totalizing the maximum amount of
9385 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9386 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009387
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009388 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009389 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009390 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9391
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009392 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9393 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009394
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009395 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009396 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009397 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009398 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9399 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009400 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009401 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009402
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009403 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9404 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009405 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009406 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009407
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009408date([<offset>]) : integer
9409 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9410 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9411 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9412 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009413 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9414
9415 Example :
9416
9417 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9418 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009419
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009420env(<name>) : string
9421 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9422 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9423 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9424 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9425 certain way.
9426
9427 Examples :
9428 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9429 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9430
9431 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9432 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009434fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9435 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009436 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9437 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009438 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9439 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9440 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9441 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9442 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009444fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9445 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9446 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9447 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9448 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9449 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9450 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9451 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9452 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009453
9454 Example :
9455 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9456 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9457 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9458 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9459 frontend mail
9460 bind :25
9461 mode tcp
9462 maxconn 100
9463 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9464 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9465 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9466 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009468nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9469 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9470 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9471 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009472 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9473 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9474 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009476queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009477 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9478 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9479 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009480 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9481 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9482 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9483 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9484 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9485
9486srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9487 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9488 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9489 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9490 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9491 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9492 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9493 methods.
9494
9495srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9496 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9497 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9498 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9499 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9500 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9501 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9502 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9503
9504srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9505 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9506 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
9507 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mosly
9508 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9509 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9510 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9511 overloading servers).
9512
9513 Example :
9514 # Redirect to a separate back
9515 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9516 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9517 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9518
9519table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9520 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9521 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9522
9523table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9524 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9525 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9526 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9527
9528
95297.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
9530----------------------------------
9531
9532The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9533closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9534methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9535sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9536TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009537the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9538counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9539"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009540argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9541the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9542this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009543
9544be_id : integer
9545 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9546 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9547
9548dst : ip
9549 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9550 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9551 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9552 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9553 RFC 4291.
9554
9555dst_conn : integer
9556 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9557 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9558 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9559 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9560 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9561 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9562 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9563 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009565dst_port : integer
9566 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9567 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9568 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9569 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9570 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9571 an HTTP header.
9572
9573fe_id : integer
9574 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9575 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9576 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9577
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009578sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9579sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9580sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9581sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009582 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9583 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9584 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9585
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009586sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9587sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9588sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9589sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009590 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9591 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9592 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9593
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009594sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9595sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9596sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9597sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009598 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9599 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009600 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9601 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9602 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009603
9604 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9605 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009606 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9607 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9608 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009609 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9610 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9611
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009612sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9613sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9614sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9615sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009616 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9617 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9618
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009619sc_conn_cur(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9620sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9621sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9622sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009623 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9624 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9625 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9626
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009627sc_conn_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9628sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9629sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9630sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009631 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9632 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9633 See also src_conn_rate.
9634
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009635sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9636sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9637sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9638sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009639 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009640 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009641
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009642sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9643sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9644sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9645sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009646 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9647 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9648 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009649 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9650 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9651 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009652
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009653sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9654sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9655sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9656sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009657 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9658 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9659 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9660
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009661sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9662sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9663sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9664sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009665 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9666 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9667 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9668 src_http_err_rate.
9669
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009670sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9671sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9672sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9673sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009674 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9675 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9676 src_http_req_cnt.
9677
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009678sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9679sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9680sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9681sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009682 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9683 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9684 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9685 src_http_req_rate.
9686
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009687sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9688sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9689sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9690sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009691 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009692 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9693 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9694 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9695 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009696
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009697 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9698 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009699 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9700
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009701sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9702sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9703sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9704sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009705 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9706 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9707 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9708 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9709
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009710sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9711sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9712sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9713sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009714 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9715 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9716 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9717 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9718
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009719sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9720sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9721sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9722sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009723 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9724 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9725 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9726 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009727 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009728 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9729
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009730sc_sess_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9731sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9732sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9733sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009734 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9735 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9736 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9737 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9738 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009739 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009740
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009741sc_tracked(<ctr>,[<table>]) : boolean
9742sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9743sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9744sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009745 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9746 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9747 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9748
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009749sc_trackers(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9750sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9751sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9752sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009753 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9754 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009755 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009756 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9757 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009758 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9759 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9760 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009762so_id : integer
9763 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9764 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9765 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009767src : ip
9768 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9769 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9770 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9771 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9772 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9773 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9774 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009775
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009776 Example:
9777 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
9778 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
9779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009780src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9781 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9782 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9783 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009784 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009786src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9787 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9788 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009789 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009790 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009792src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9793 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9794 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9795 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9796 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9797 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9798 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009799
9800 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9801 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9802 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9803 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009804 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009805 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9806 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009808src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009809 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009810 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009811 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009812 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009814src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009815 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009816 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9817 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009818 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009820src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9821 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
9822 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9823 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009824 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009826src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009827 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009828 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009829 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009830 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009832src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009833 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009834 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009835 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
9836 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009837 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9838 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9839 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009841src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9842 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
9843 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009844 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009845 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009846 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009848src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9849 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
9850 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9851 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9852 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009853 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009855src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9856 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9857 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9858 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009859 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009861src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9862 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9863 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9864 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009865 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009866 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009868src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9869 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9870 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9871 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009872 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009873 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
9874 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009875
9876 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009877 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009878 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009880src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9881 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
9882 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9883 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
9884 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009885 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
9886 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009888src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9889 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
9890 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009891 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
9892 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009893 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009895src_port : integer
9896 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
9897 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
9898 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
9899 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009901src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9902 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009903 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9904 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
9905 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009906 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009908src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9909 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
9910 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9911 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9912 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009913 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009915src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9916 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
9917 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
9918 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
9919 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
9920 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
9921 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
9922 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
9923 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009924
9925 Example :
9926 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
9927 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
9928 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
9929 listen ssh
9930 bind :22
9931 mode tcp
9932 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009933 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009934 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009935 server local 127.0.0.1:22
9936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009937srv_id : integer
9938 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
9939 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
9940 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02009941
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01009942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020099437.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
9944----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02009945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009946The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
9947closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
9948when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
9949usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
9950future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negociations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009952ssl_c_ca_err : integer
9953 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9954 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
9955 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
9956 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
9957 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009959ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
9960 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9961 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
9962 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
9963 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009965ssl_c_err : integer
9966 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9967 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
9968 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
9969 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
9970 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009972ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9973 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9974 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9975 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9976 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9977 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9978 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9979 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9980 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009982 ACL derivatives :
9983 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009985ssl_c_key_alg : string
9986 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9987 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9988 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009990 ACL derivatives :
9991 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009993ssl_c_notafter : string
9994 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
9995 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9996 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009998 ACL derivatives :
9999 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010001ssl_c_notbefore : string
10002 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10003 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10004 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010006 ACL derivatives :
10007 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010009ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10010 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10011 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10012 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10013 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10014 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10015 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10016 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10017 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010019 ACL derivatives :
10020 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010022ssl_c_serial : binary
10023 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10024 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10025 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010027 ACL derivatives :
10028 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010030ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10031 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10032 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10033 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010035ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10036 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10037 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10038 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010040 ACL derivatives :
10041 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
10042
10043ssl_c_used : boolean
10044 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10045 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010047ssl_c_verify : integer
10048 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10049 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10050 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10051 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010053ssl_c_version : integer
10054 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10055 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010057ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10058 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10059 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10060 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10061 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010062 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010063 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10064 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10065 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010067 ACL derivatives :
10068 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010070ssl_f_key_alg : string
10071 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10072 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10073 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010075 ACL derivatives :
10076 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010078ssl_f_notafter : string
10079 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10080 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10081 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010083 ACL derivatives :
10084 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010086ssl_f_notbefore : string
10087 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10088 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10089 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010091 ACL derivatives :
10092 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010094ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10095 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10096 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10097 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10098 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10099 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10100 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10101 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10102 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010104 ACL derivatives :
10105 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010107ssl_f_serial : binary
10108 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10109 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10110 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010112 ACL derivatives :
10113 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010115ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10116 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10117 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10118 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010120 ACL derivatives :
10121 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010123ssl_f_version : integer
10124 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10125 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10126
10127ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010128 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10129 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10130 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010132 Example :
10133 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10134 listen http-https
10135 bind :80
10136 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10137 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10138
10139ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10140 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10141 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10142
10143ssl_fc_alpn : string
10144 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negociation field from an
10145 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10146 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10147 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10148 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10149 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10150 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10151 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10152 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10153
10154 ACL derivatives :
10155 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010157ssl_fc_cipher : string
10158 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10159 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010161 ACL derivatives :
10162 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010164ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010165 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10166 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010167 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10168 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10169 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10170 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010172ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10173 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010174 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10175 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10176 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10177 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010179ssl_fc_npn : string
10180 This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an incoming connection
10181 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10182 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10183 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10184 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10185 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10186 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10187 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010189 ACL derivatives :
10190 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010192ssl_fc_protocol : string
10193 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10194 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010196 ACL derivatives :
10197 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
10198
10199ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10200 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10201 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10202 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10203 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010205ssl_fc_sni : string
10206 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10207 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10208 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10209 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10210 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10211
10212 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10213 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10214 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010215 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10216 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010218 ACL derivatives :
10219 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
10220 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10221 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010223ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10224 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10225 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010226
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200102287.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
10229------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010231Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10232sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10233only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10234For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10235be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10236can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10237sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10238for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10239content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010241payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10242 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10243 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10244 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010246payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10247 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10248 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10249 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010251req.len : integer
10252req_len : integer (deprecated)
10253 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10254 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10255 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10256 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10257 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10258 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10259 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10260 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010262req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10263 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010264 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10265 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10266 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10267 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010269 ACL alternatives :
10270 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010272req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10273 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10274 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10275 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10276 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010278 ACL alternatives :
10279 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010281 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010283req.proto_http : boolean
10284req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10285 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10286 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10287 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10288 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10289 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10290 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10291 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010293 Example:
10294 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10295 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10296 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010297 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010299req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10300rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10301 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10302 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10303 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10304 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10305 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10306 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10307 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010309 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10310 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10311 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10312 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10313 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10314 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010316 ACL derivatives :
10317 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010319 Example :
10320 listen tse-farm
10321 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10322 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10323 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10324 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10325 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10326 persist rdp-cookie
10327 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10328 # This is only useful makes sense if
10329 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10330 stick-table type string size 204800
10331 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10332 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10333 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010335 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10336 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010338req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10339rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10340 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10341 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10342 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10343 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010345 ACL derivatives :
10346 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010348req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10349req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10350 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10351 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10352 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10353 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10354 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10355 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10356 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010358req.ssl_sni : string
10359req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10360 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10361 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10362 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10363 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10364 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10365 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10366 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10367 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10368 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10369 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10370 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10371 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010373 ACL derivatives :
10374 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010376 Examples :
10377 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10378 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10379 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10380 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10381 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010383res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10384rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10385 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10386 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10387 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10388 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10389 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10390 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10391 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010393req.ssl_ver : integer
10394req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10395 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10396 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10397 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10398 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10399 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10400 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10401 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10402 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10403 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010405 ACL derivatives :
10406 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010407
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010408res.len : integer
10409 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10410 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10411 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10412 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10413 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10414 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10415 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10416 content inspection.
10417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010418res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10419 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010420 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10421 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10422 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10423 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010425res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10426 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10427 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10428 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10429 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010431 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010433wait_end : boolean
10434 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10435 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10436 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10437 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10438 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10439 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10440 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10441 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010443 Examples :
10444 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10445 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10446 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010448 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10449 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10450 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10451 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10452 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10453 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10454 tcp-request content reject
10455
10456
104577.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
10458--------------------------------------
10459
10460It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10461This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10462data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10463its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10464HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10465content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10466to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10467more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10468response are indexed.
10469
10470base : string
10471 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10472 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10473 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10474 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10475 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10476 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10477 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10478 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10479
10480 ACL derivatives :
10481 base : exact string match
10482 base_beg : prefix match
10483 base_dir : subdir match
10484 base_dom : domain match
10485 base_end : suffix match
10486 base_len : length match
10487 base_reg : regex match
10488 base_sub : substring match
10489
10490base32 : integer
10491 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10492 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10493 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10494 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10495
10496base32+src : binary
10497 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10498 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10499 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10500 per-URL counters.
10501
10502req.cook([<name>]) : string
10503cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10504 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10505 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10506 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10507 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10508 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10509 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10510 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10511 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10512
10513 ACL derivatives :
10514 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10515 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10516 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10517 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10518 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10519 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10520 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10521 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010523req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10524cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10525 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10526 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010528req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10529cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10530 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10531 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10532 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10533 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010535cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10536 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10537 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10538 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10539 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10540 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10541 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10542 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10543 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10544 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10545 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010546
William Lallemanda43ba4e2014-01-28 18:14:25 +010010547capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
10548 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
10549 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10550 See also: "capture request header"
10551
10552capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
10553 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
10554 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10555 See also: "capture response header"
10556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010557hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10558 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10559 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10560 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10561 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
10562 unambiguouslly apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010564req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10565 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10566 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10567 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10568 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10569 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10570 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10571 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10572 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010574req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10575 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10576 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10577 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10578 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010580req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10581 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10582 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10583 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10584 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10585 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10586 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10587 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10588 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10589 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10590 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10591 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010593 ACL derivatives :
10594 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10595 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10596 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10597 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10598 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10599 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10600 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10601 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10602
10603req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10604hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10605 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10606 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10607 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10608 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10609 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10610 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10611 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10612 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10613 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10614
10615req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10616hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10617 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10618 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10619 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10620 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10621 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10622 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10623 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10624 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10625
10626req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10627hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10628 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10629 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10630 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10631 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10632 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10633 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10634 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10635
10636http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10637 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10638 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10639 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10640 basic auth is supported.
10641
10642http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group
10643 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10644 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist, and
10645 whether that username belongs to one of the groups supplied in ACL patterns.
10646 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10647 basic auth is supported.
10648
10649 ACL derivatives :
10650 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : user group match
10651
10652http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010653 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10654 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010655 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10656 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010658method : integer + string
10659 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10660 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10661 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10662 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10663 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10664 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10665 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010667 ACL derivatives :
10668 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010670 Example :
10671 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10672 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10673 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010675path : string
10676 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10677 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10678 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10679 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10680 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10681 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10682 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010684 ACL derivatives :
10685 path : exact string match
10686 path_beg : prefix match
10687 path_dir : subdir match
10688 path_dom : domain match
10689 path_end : suffix match
10690 path_len : length match
10691 path_reg : regex match
10692 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010694req.ver : string
10695req_ver : string (deprecated)
10696 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10697 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10698 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010700 ACL derivatives :
10701 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010703res.comp : boolean
10704 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10705 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10706 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010708res.comp_algo : string
10709 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10710 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10711 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010713res.cook([<name>]) : string
10714scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10715 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10716 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10717 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010719 ACL derivatives :
10720 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010722res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10723scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10724 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10725 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10726 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010728res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10729scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10730 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10731 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10732 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010734res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10735 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10736 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10737 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10738 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10739 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10740 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10741 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10742 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10743 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010745res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10746 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10747 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10748 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10749 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10750 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010752res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10753shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10754 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10755 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10756 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10757 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10758 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10759 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10760 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10761 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010763 ACL derivatives :
10764 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10765 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10766 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10767 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10768 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10769 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10770 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10771 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10772
10773res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10774shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10775 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10776 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10777 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10778 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10779 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010781res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10782shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10783 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10784 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10785 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10786 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10787 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10788 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010790res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10791shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10792 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10793 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10794 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10795 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10796 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10797 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010799res.ver : string
10800resp_ver : string (deprecated)
10801 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
10802 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010804 ACL derivatives :
10805 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010807set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10808 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10809 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
10810 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
10811 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010813 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
10814 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010816 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010818status : integer
10819 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
10820 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
10821 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010823url : string
10824 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
10825 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
10826 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
10827 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
10828 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
10829 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
10830 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010832 ACL derivatives :
10833 url : exact string match
10834 url_beg : prefix match
10835 url_dir : subdir match
10836 url_dom : domain match
10837 url_end : suffix match
10838 url_len : length match
10839 url_reg : regex match
10840 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010842url_ip : ip
10843 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
10844 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
10845 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
10846 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
10847 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
10848 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10849 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010851url_port : integer
10852 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
10853 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
10854 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10855 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010857urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10858url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10859 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
10860 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
10861 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
10862 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
10863 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
10864 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
10865 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
10866 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
10867 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010869 ACL derivatives :
10870 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
10871 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
10872 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
10873 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
10874 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
10875 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
10876 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
10877 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010878
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010880 Example :
10881 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
10882 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
10883 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
10884 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010886urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
10887 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
10888 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
10889 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020010890
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010010891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200108927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010893---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010894
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010895Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
10896every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010897order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010898
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010899ACL name Equivalent to Usage
10900---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010901FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010902HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010903HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
10904HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010905HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
10906HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
10907HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
10908HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
10909LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010910METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
10911METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
10912METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
10913METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
10914METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
10915METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010916RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010917REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010918TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010919WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
10920---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010921
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109238. Logging
10924----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010925
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010926One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
10927provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
10928very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
10929provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
10930state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010931to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010932headers.
10933
10934In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
10935about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
10936send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
10937
10938 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
10939 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
10940 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
10941 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
10942 at the termination.
10943
10944The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
10945allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
10946as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
10947while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
10948real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
10949delay.
10950
10951
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109528.1. Log levels
10953---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010954
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010955TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010956source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010957HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
10958in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
10959track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
10960syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
10961about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010962
10963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109648.2. Log formats
10965----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010966
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010967HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010968and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
10969slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
10970options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010971
10972 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
10973 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
10974 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
10975 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
10976 extents.
10977
10978 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
10979 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
10980 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
10981 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
10982 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
10983
10984 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
10985 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
10986 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
10987 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
10988 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
10989
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010990 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
10991 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
10992 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
10993 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
10994
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010995 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
10996
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010997Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
10998specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
10999field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11000servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11001always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11002identifier.
11003
11004Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11005 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11006 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11007 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11008 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11009
11010
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110118.2.1. Default log format
11012-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011013
11014This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11015as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11016format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11017
11018 Example :
11019 listen www
11020 mode http
11021 log global
11022 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11023
11024 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11025 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11026 (www/HTTP)
11027
11028 Field Format Extract from the example above
11029 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11030 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11031 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11032 4 'to' to
11033 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11034 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11035
11036Detailed fields description :
11037 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11038 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11039 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11040 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11041 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11042 and processed the connection.
11043 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11044
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011045In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11046"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11047connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11048
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011049It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11050will eventually disappear.
11051
11052
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110538.2.2. TCP log format
11054---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011055
11056The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11057is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11058information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11059counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11060emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11061environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11062the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11063sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011064specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11065not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11066fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11067marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011068
11069 Example :
11070 frontend fnt
11071 mode tcp
11072 option tcplog
11073 log global
11074 default_backend bck
11075
11076 backend bck
11077 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11078
11079 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11080 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11081 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11082
11083 Field Format Extract from the example above
11084 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11085 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11086 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11087 4 frontend_name fnt
11088 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11089 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11090 7 bytes_read* 212
11091 8 termination_state --
11092 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11093 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11094
11095Detailed fields description :
11096 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011097 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11098 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11099 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11100 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11101 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011102
11103 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011104 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11105 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11106 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011107
11108 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11109 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11110 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11111 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11112
11113 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11114 and processed the connection.
11115
11116 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11117 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11118 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11119 applications.
11120
11121 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11122 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11123 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11124 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11125 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11126
11127 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11128 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11129 See "Timers" below for more details.
11130
11131 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11132 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11133 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11134 "Timers" below for more details.
11135
11136 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
11137 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
11138 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11139 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11140 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11141 details.
11142
11143 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11144 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11145 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11146 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11147 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11148
11149 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11150 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11151 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11152 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11153 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11154 for more details.
11155
11156 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011157 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011158 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11159 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11160 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011161 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011162
11163 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11164 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11165 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11166 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11167 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11168 caused by a denial of service attack.
11169
11170 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11171 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11172 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11173 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11174 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11175 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11176 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11177 denial of service attack.
11178
11179 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11180 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11181 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11182 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11183 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11184 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11185 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11186 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11187 be processed than on other servers.
11188
11189 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11190 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11191 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11192 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11193 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11194 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11195 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11196 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11197 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11198 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11199 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11200 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11201 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11202
11203 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11204 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11205 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11206 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11207 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11208 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11209 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11210 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11211
11212 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11213 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11214 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11215 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11216 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11217 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11218 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11219 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11220 occurs.
11221
11222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112238.2.3. HTTP log format
11224----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011225
11226The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11227is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11228the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11229are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11230emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11231generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11232"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11233which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011234frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11235is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011236
11237Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11238slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11239with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11240
11241 Example :
11242 frontend http-in
11243 mode http
11244 option httplog
11245 log global
11246 default_backend bck
11247
11248 backend static
11249 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11250
11251 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11252 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11253 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011254 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011255
11256 Field Format Extract from the example above
11257 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11258 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11259 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11260 4 frontend_name http-in
11261 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11262 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11263 7 status_code 200
11264 8 bytes_read* 2750
11265 9 captured_request_cookie -
11266 10 captured_response_cookie -
11267 11 termination_state ----
11268 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11269 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11270 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11271 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11272 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011273
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011274
11275Detailed fields description :
11276 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011277 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11278 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11279 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11280 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11281 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011282
11283 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011284 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11285 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11286 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011287
11288 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11289 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11290 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11291 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11292 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11293
11294 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11295 and processed the connection.
11296
11297 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11298 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11299 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11300
11301 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11302 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11303 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11304 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11305 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11306 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11307
11308 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11309 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11310 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11311 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11312 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11313 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11314
11315 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11316 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11317 See "Timers" below for more details.
11318
11319 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11320 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11321 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11322 below for more details.
11323
11324 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11325 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11326 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11327 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11328 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11329 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11330 for more details.
11331
11332 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
11333 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
11334 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11335 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11336 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11337 details.
11338
11339 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11340 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11341 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11342
11343 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11344 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11345 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11346 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11347 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11348 overflowing.
11349
11350 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11351 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11352 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11353 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11354 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11355 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11356 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11357 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11358
11359 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11360 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11361 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11362 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11363 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11364 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11365 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11366 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11367
11368 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11369 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11370 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11371 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11372 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11373 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11374 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11375
11376 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011377 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011378 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11379 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11380 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011381 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011382 system.
11383
11384 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11385 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11386 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11387 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11388 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11389 caused by a denial of service attack.
11390
11391 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11392 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11393 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11394 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11395 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11396 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11397 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11398 denial of service attack.
11399
11400 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11401 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11402 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11403 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11404 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11405 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11406 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11407 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11408 processed than on other servers.
11409
11410 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11411 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11412 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11413 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11414 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11415 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11416 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11417 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11418 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11419 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11420 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11421 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11422 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11423
11424 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11425 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11426 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11427 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11428 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11429 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11430 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11431 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11432
11433 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11434 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11435 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11436 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11437 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11438 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11439 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11440 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11441 occurs.
11442
11443 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11444 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11445 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11446 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11447 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11448 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11449 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11450 cookies" below for more details.
11451
11452 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11453 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11454 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11455 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11456 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11457 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11458 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11459 and cookies" below for more details.
11460
11461 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11462 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11463 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11464 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11465 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11466 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11467 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11468 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11469
11470
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200114718.2.4. Custom log format
11472------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011473
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011474The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011475mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011476
11477HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11478Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11479separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11480prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11481
11482Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11483variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11484string formats ("Q").
11485
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011486If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011487as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011488less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11489the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11490
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011491Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011492In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceeded by another '%' resulting
11493in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011494
11495Flags are :
11496 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011497 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011498
11499 Example:
11500
11501 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11502 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11503
11504At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11505
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011506 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11507 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011508
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011509the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011510
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011511 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011512 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011513 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011514
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011515and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11516
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011517 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011518 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11519
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011520Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11521
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011522 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011523 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011524 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11525 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11526 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011527 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11528 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11529 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011530 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011531 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011532 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011533 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011534 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011535 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011536 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11537 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011538 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011539 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11540 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011541 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011542 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11543 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011544 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11545 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11546 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011547 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011548 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11549 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011550 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011551 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11552 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11553 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011554 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011555 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11556 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11557 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11558 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011559 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011560 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011561 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011562 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010011563 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011564 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011565 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11566 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11567 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011568 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011569 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11570 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011571 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011572 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011573 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011574 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011575
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011576 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011577
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011578
115798.2.5. Error log format
11580-----------------------
11581
11582When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11583protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11584By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11585"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11586will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11587logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11588
11589The format looks like this :
11590
11591 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11592 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11593 Connection error during SSL handshake
11594
11595 Field Format Extract from the example above
11596 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11597 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11598 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11599 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11600 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11601
11602These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11603failures.
11604
11605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116068.3. Advanced logging options
11607-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011608
11609Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11610just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11611options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11612for more information about their usage.
11613
11614
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116158.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11616------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011617
11618It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11619haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11620commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11621monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11622ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11623
11624 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11625 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11626 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11627 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11628
11629 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11630 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11631 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
11632 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
11633 such as other load-balancers.
11634
11635 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11636 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11637 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11638
11639
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116408.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11641----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011642
11643The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11644what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11645or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11646"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11647just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11648log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11649after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11650is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11651with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11652with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11653
11654
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116558.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11656------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011657
11658Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11659for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11660"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11661retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11662raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11663a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11664file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11665you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11666"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11667
11668
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116698.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11670--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011671
11672Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11673multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11674them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11675"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11676logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11677error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11678and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11679too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11680useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11681alternative.
11682
11683
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116848.4. Timing events
11685------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011686
11687Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11688reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11689the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11690frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11691mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11692
11693 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11694 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11695 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11696 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11697 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11698
11699 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11700 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11701 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11702 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11703 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11704
11705 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11706 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11707 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11708 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11709 connection never established.
11710
11711 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11712 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11713 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11714 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11715 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11716 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11717 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11718 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11719 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11720 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11721 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11722
11723 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11724 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11725 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11726 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
11727 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
11728
11729 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11730
11731 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11732 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11733 negative.
11734
11735These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11736protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11737that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011738due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011739close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11740session has been aborted on timeout.
11741
11742Most common cases :
11743
11744 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11745 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11746 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11747 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11748 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11749 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11750 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11751 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11752 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011753 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11754 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11755 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011756
11757 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11758 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11759 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11760 of ms on remote networks.
11761
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011762 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11763 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11764 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011765
11766 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11767 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11768 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11769 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11770 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11771 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11772 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11773 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11774 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11775 to the server until another one is released.
11776
11777Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11778
11779 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11780 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11781 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11782
11783 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11784 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11785 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11786
11787 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11788 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11789 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11790 flags.
11791
11792 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11793 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11794 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11795 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11796 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11797 the client connection was maintained open.
11798
11799 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
11800 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
11801 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
11802 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
11803
11804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118058.5. Session state at disconnection
11806-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011807
11808TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
11809"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
118102-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
11811each of which has a special meaning :
11812
11813 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
11814 session to terminate :
11815
11816 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
11817
11818 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
11819 server explicitly refused it.
11820
11821 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
11822 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
11823 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
11824 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011825 (eg: cacheable cookie).
11826
11827 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
11828 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011829
11830 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
11831 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
11832 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
11833 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
11834 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
11835
11836 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
11837 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
11838 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
11839 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
11840 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
11841
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090011842 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
11843 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
11844
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011845 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
11846 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
11847 backup connections when going up.
11848
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020011849 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
11850
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011851 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
11852 send or receive data.
11853
11854 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
11855 send or receive data.
11856
11857 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
11858 with nothing left in the buffers.
11859
11860 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
11861
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010011862 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011863 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
11864
11865 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
11866 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
11867 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
11868 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
11869 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
11870
11871 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
11872 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
11873
11874 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
11875 server (HTTP only).
11876
11877 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
11878
11879 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
11880 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
11881 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
11882
11883 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
11884 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
11885 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
11886
11887 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
11888
11889 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
11890 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
11891
11892 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
11893 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
11894 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
11895
11896 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
11897 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020011898 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
11899 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011900
11901 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
11902 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
11903 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
11904 another server.
11905
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011906 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011907 server.
11908
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011909 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
11910 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
11911 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
11912 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11913
11914 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
11915 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
11916 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
11917 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11918
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020011919 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
11920 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
11921 "use-server" rule).
11922
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011923 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11924
11925 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
11926 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
11927
11928 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
11929
11930 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
11931 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
11932 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
11933
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011934 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
11935 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
11936 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
11937 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
11938 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
11939
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011940 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
11941
11942 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
11943 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
11944
11945 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
11946
11947 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11948
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011949The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
11950was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011951helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
11952starvation, attacks, etc...
11953
11954The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
11955alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
11956easier finding and understanding.
11957
11958 Flags Reason
11959
11960 -- Normal termination.
11961
11962 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
11963 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
11964 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
11965 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
11966
11967 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
11968 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
11969 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
11970 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
11971 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
11972 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011973
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011974 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11975 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011976 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011977
11978 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
11979 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
11980 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
11981
11982 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
11983 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
11984 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
11985 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
11986 the server takes too long to respond.
11987
11988 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
11989 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
11990 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
11991 long a time to respond.
11992
11993 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
11994 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
11995 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
11996 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
11997 and the client.
11998
11999 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12000 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12001 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12002 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12003 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
12004 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
12005
12006 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12007 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012008 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12009 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12010 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12011 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012012
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012013 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12014 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012016 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012017 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12018 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12019 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12020 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12021 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12022
12023 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12024 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12025 503 or 504 here.
12026
12027 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12028 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12029 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12030 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12031 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12032
12033 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12034 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012035 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012036 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12037 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12038
12039 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12040 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12041 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12042 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12043 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12044 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12045 between haproxy and the server.
12046
12047 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12048 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12049 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12050 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12051 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12052 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12053 solution is to fix the application.
12054
12055 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12056 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12057 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12058 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12059 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12060 external attacks.
12061
12062 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12063 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012064 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012065 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12066 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12067
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012068 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12069 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12070 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012071 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12072 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012073
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012074 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12075 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12076 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12077 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012078 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12079 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12080 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12081 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12082 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012083
12084 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12085 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12086 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12087 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12088
12089 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12090 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12091 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12092 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12093
12094 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12095 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12096 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12097 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12098
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012099The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12100persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12101important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12102re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12103
12104 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12105
12106 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12107 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12108 set on a GET request.
12109
12110 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12111 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012112 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012113 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12114
12115 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12116 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12117 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12118
12119 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12120 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12121 already got a cookie.
12122
12123 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12124 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12125 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12126 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12127 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12128
12129 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12130 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12131 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12132
12133 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12134 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12135 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12136
12137 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12138 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12139
12140 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12141 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12142 then advertised in the response.
12143
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121458.6. Non-printable characters
12146-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012147
12148In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12149consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12150converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12151prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12152being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12153escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12154is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12155'}' when logging headers.
12156
12157Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12158issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12159containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12160
12161Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12162the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12163performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12164
12165
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121668.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12167---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012168
12169Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12170achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012171section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012172cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12173the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12174the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012175locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012176not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12177user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12178a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12179wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12180
12181 Examples :
12182 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12183 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12184
12185 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12186 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12187
12188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121898.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12190---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012191
12192Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12193proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12194the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12195server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12196
12197Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12198response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012199section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012200
12201It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012202time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12203appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012204are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12205and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12206follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12207request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12208in the logs.
12209
12210 Example :
12211 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12212 listen proxy-out
12213 mode http
12214 option httplog
12215 option logasap
12216 log global
12217 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12218
12219 # log the name of the virtual server
12220 capture request header Host len 20
12221
12222 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12223 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12224
12225 # log the beginning of the referrer
12226 capture request header Referer len 20
12227
12228 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12229 capture response header Server len 20
12230
12231 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12232 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12233
12234 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12235 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12236
12237 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12238 capture response header Via len 20
12239
12240 # log the URL location during a redirection
12241 capture response header Location len 20
12242
12243 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12244 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12245 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12246 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12247 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12248
12249 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12250 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12251 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12252 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012253 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012254
12255 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12256 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12257 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12258 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12259 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012260 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012261
12262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122638.9. Examples of logs
12264---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012265
12266These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12267them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12268reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12269
12270 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12271 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12272 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12273
12274 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12275 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12276
12277 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12278 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12279 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12280
12281 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12282 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12283
12284 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12285 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12286 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12287
12288 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012289 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012290 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12291 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12292
12293 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12294 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12295 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12296
12297 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12298 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012299 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012300 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12301 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12302 to return the 502 and not the server.
12303
12304 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012305 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012306
12307 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12308 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12309 Nothing was sent to any server.
12310
12311 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12312 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12313
12314 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12315 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12316 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12317 send a 408 return code to the client.
12318
12319 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12320 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12321
12322 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12323 5 seconds ("c----").
12324
12325 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12326 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012327 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012328
12329 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012330 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012331 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12332 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12333 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12334 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12335 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012336
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123389. Statistics and monitoring
12339----------------------------
12340
12341It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12342mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12343CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12344Unix socket.
12345
12346
123479.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012348---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012349
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012350The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12351page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12352
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012353 0. pxname: proxy name
12354 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12355 for server)
12356 2. qcur: current queued requests
12357 3. qmax: max queued requests
12358 4. scur: current sessions
12359 5. smax: max sessions
12360 6. slim: sessions limit
12361 7. stot: total sessions
12362 8. bin: bytes in
12363 9. bout: bytes out
12364 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012365 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012366 12. ereq: request errors
12367 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012368 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012369 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12370 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012371 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012372 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12373 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12374 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12375 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12376 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12377 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12378 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12379 25. qlimit: queue limit
12380 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12381 27. iid: unique proxy id
12382 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12383 29. throttle: warm up status
12384 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12385 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012386 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012387 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12388 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12389 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012390 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012391 UNK -> unknown
12392 INI -> initializing
12393 SOCKERR -> socket error
12394 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12395 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12396 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12397 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12398 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12399 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12400 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12401 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12402 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12403 disable-on-404
12404 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12405 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12406 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012407 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12408 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012409 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12410 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12411 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12412 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12413 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12414 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012415 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12416 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12417 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12418 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012419 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12420 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012421 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12422 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12423 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012424 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012425
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124279.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012428-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012429
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012430The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12431necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12432A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12433issuing commands by hand :
12434
12435 global
12436 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12437 stats timeout 2m
12438
12439It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12440the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12441never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12442situations :
12443
12444 global
12445 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12446 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12447 stats timeout 2m
12448
12449To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12450swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12451to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12452syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12453
12454 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12455 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12456
12457The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12458script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12459for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12460
12461The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12462that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12463editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12464(eg: watch a counter).
12465
12466The socket supports two operation modes :
12467 - interactive
12468 - non-interactive
12469
12470The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12471this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12472sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12473mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12474commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12475example :
12476
12477 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12478
12479The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12480entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12481for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12482sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12483"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12484after processing the last command of the same line.
12485
12486For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12487"prompt" command :
12488
12489 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12490 prompt
12491 > show info
12492 ...
12493 >
12494
12495Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12496delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12497that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12498parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012499
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012500It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12501on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12502own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012503
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012504The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12505If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12506all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12507it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12508
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012509add map <map> <key> <value>
12510 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12511 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
12512 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation.
12513
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012514clear counters
12515 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12516 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12517 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12518 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12519 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12520
12521clear counters all
12522 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12523 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12524 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12525
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012526clear map <map>
12527 Remove all entries from the map <map>.
12528
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012529clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12530 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12531
12532 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12533 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12534 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12535 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12536 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12537 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12538
12539 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12540
12541 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12542 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12543 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12544 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12545 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12546 the ACLs :
12547
12548 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12549 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12550 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12551 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12552 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12553 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12554
12555 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012556 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12557 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012558
12559 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012560 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012561 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012562 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12563 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12564 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12565 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012566
12567 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12568
12569 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012570 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012571 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12572 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012573 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12574 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12575 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012576
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010012577del map <map> <key>
12578 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
12579
12580disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012581 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
12582
12583 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
12584 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
12585 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
12586 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
12587 re-enabled using enable agent.
12588
12589 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
12590 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
12591 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
12592 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
12593 otherwise unchanged.
12594
12595 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
12596 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
12597 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
12598
12599 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12600 level "admin".
12601
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012602disable frontend <frontend>
12603 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12604 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12605 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12606 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12607 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12608 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12609 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12610 on the stats page.
12611
12612 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12613 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12614
12615 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12616 level "admin".
12617
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012618disable server <backend>/<server>
12619 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12620 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12621 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12622 during the maintenance.
12623
12624 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12625 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12626
12627 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012628 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012629
12630 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12631 level "admin".
12632
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012633enable agent <backend>/<server>
12634 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
12635
12636 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
12637 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
12638
12639 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12640 level "admin".
12641
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012642enable frontend <frontend>
12643 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12644 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12645 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12646 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12647 which was disabled.
12648
12649 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12650 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12651
12652 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12653 level "admin".
12654
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012655enable server <backend>/<server>
12656 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12657 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12658
12659 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012660 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012661
12662 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12663 level "admin".
12664
12665get weight <backend>/<server>
12666 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12667 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12668 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12669 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12670 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012671 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012672
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012673help
12674 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12675 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012676
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012677prompt
12678 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12679 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12680 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12681 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12682 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12683 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12684 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12685 command.
12686
12687quit
12688 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012689
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012690set map <map> <key> <value>
12691 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. The new value
12692 is <value>.
12693
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012694set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012695 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12696 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12697 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12698 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12699 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012700 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12701 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12702
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012703set maxconn global <maxconn>
12704 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12705 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12706 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12707 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12708 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12709 setting.
12710
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012711set rate-limit connections global <value>
12712 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12713 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12714 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12715 is passed in number of connections per second.
12716
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012717set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
12718 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
12719 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010012720 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
12721 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012722
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020012723set rate-limit sessions global <value>
12724 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
12725 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12726 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12727 is passed in number of sessions per second.
12728
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020012729set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
12730 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
12731 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12732 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12733 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
12734 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
12735
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012736set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012737 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
12738 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
12739 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
12740 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012741 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
12742 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012743
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012744set timeout cli <delay>
12745 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
12746 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
12747 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
12748
12749set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
12750 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
12751 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090012752 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
12753 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
12754 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
12755 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
12756 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
12757 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
12758 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
12759 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
12760 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
12761 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
12762 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
12763 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
12764 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012765
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012766show errors [<iid>]
12767 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
12768 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012769 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
12770 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
12771 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012772
12773 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
12774 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
12775 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
12776 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
12777 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
12778 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
12779 are reported too.
12780
12781 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
12782 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
12783 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
12784 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
12785 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
12786 code.
12787
12788 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
12789 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
12790 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
12791 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
12792 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
12793 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
12794 line.
12795
12796 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012797 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12798 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012799 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
12800 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
12801
12802 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
12803 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
12804 00038 Location: blah\r\n
12805 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
12806 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
12807 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
12808 00204+ minal\r\n
12809 00211 \r\n
12810
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012811 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012812 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
12813 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
12814 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
12815 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
12816 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
12817 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012818
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012819show info
12820 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
12821
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012822show map [<map>]
12823 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
12824 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped.
12825
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010012826show pools
12827 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
12828 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
12829 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
12830 the pools.
12831
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012832show sess
12833 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012834 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
12835 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12836
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010012837show sess <id>
12838 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
12839 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12840 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
12841 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
12842 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010012843 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
12844 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
12845 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012846
12847show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
12848 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
12849 possible to dump only selected items :
12850 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
12851 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
12852 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
12853 for example:
12854 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
12855 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
12856 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
12857
12858 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012859 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
12860 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012861 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
12862 Release_date: 2009/09/23
12863 Nbproc: 1
12864 Process_num: 1
12865 (...)
12866
12867 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
12868 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
12869 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
12870 (...)
12871 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
12872
12873 $
12874
12875 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
12876 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
12877 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
12878 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012879 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012880
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012881show table
12882 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
12883 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
12884 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
12885 entries currently in use.
12886
12887 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012888 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012889 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
12890 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012891
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012892show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012893 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
12894 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
12895 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012896 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
12897
12898 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
12899 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
12900 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
12901 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
12902 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
12903
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012904 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12905 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12906 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12907 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12908 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12909 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12910
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012911
12912 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012913 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
12914 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012915
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012916 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012917 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012918 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012919 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12920 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12921 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12922 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012923
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012924 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012925 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012926 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12927 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012928
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012929 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
12930 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012931 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012932 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12933 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012934
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012935 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
12936 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012937 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012938 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12939 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
12940
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012941 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
12942 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
12943 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
12944 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
12945 time goes, the average event rate drops.
12946
12947 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
12948 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
12949 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012950 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
12951 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012952 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
12953 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020012954
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012955shutdown frontend <frontend>
12956 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
12957 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
12958 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
12959 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
12960 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
12961 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
12962 once it is terminated.
12963
12964 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12965 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12966
12967 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12968 level "admin".
12969
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020012970shutdown session <id>
12971 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
12972 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12973 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
12974 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
12975 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
12976 flag in the logs.
12977
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020012978shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
12979 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
12980 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
12981 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
12982 'K' flag in the logs.
12983
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012984/*
12985 * Local variables:
12986 * fill-column: 79
12987 * End:
12988 */